1 ==============================
2 LLVM Language Reference Manual
3 ==============================
12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30 representation and notation.
32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41 instead of a memory location.
48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73 identifiers, for different purposes:
75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
78 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
79 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
82 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global values to suppress mangling.
84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
111 After strength reduction:
115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126 lexical features of LLVM:
128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139 that defines the type and name of value produced.
147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
162 ; Definition of main function
163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8*...
165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with a private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206 ``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
244 .. _linkage_appending:
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
275 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
276 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
283 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
290 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
315 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
327 floating-point types are supported.
328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
329 floating-point parameters.
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
349 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
361 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
394 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
415 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
435 "``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
439 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
444 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
448 .. _visibilitystyles:
453 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
456 "``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463 "``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469 "``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
475 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
483 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
501 Thread Local Storage Models
502 ---------------------------
504 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507 TLS model may be specified:
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
516 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
518 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520 more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
524 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
525 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
527 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
530 .. _runtime_preemption_model:
532 Runtime Preemption Specifiers
533 -----------------------------
535 Global variables, functions and aliases may have an optional runtime preemption
536 specifier. If a preemption specifier isn't given explicitly, then a
537 symbol is assumed to be ``dso_preemptable``.
540 Indicates that the function or variable may be replaced by a symbol from
541 outside the linkage unit at runtime.
544 The compiler may assume that a function or variable marked as ``dso_local``
545 will resolve to a symbol within the same linkage unit. Direct access will
546 be generated even if the definition is not within this compilation unit.
553 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
554 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
555 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
556 to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
558 An example of an identified structure specification is:
562 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
564 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
565 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
569 Non-Integral Pointer Type
570 -------------------------
572 Note: non-integral pointer types are a work in progress, and they should be
573 considered experimental at this time.
575 LLVM IR optionally allows the frontend to denote pointers in certain address
576 spaces as "non-integral" via the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
577 Non-integral pointer types represent pointers that have an *unspecified* bitwise
578 representation; that is, the integral representation may be target dependent or
579 unstable (not backed by a fixed integer).
581 ``inttoptr`` instructions converting integers to non-integral pointer types are
582 ill-typed, and so are ``ptrtoint`` instructions converting values of
583 non-integral pointer types to integers. Vector versions of said instructions
584 are ill-typed as well.
591 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
594 Global variable definitions must be initialized.
596 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
597 case they don't have an initializer.
599 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
600 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. If there
601 is a mismatch between the explicit or inferred section information for the
602 variable declaration and its definition the resulting behavior is undefined.
604 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
605 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
606 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
607 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
608 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
611 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
612 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
613 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
614 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
615 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
616 units that do not include the definition.
618 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
619 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
620 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
621 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
624 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
625 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
626 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
627 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
628 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
629 whose address is significant.
631 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
632 not be significant within the module.
634 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
635 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
636 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
637 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
638 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
640 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
641 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
642 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
645 External declarations may have an explicit section specified. Section
646 information is retained in LLVM IR for targets that make use of this
647 information. Attaching section information to an external declaration is an
648 assertion that its definition is located in the specified section. If the
649 definition is located in a different section, the behavior is undefined.
651 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
652 variables defined within the module are not modified from their
653 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
654 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
655 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
656 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
657 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
659 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
660 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
661 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
662 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
663 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
664 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
665 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
666 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
667 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
668 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
670 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
671 an optional :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`,
672 an optional :ref:`global attributes <glattrs>` and
673 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`.
675 Variables and aliases can have a
676 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
678 :ref:`Scalable vectors <t_vector>` cannot be global variables or members of
679 structs or arrays because their size is unknown at compile time.
683 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility]
684 [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
685 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
686 [ExternallyInitialized]
687 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
688 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
689 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
691 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
692 with an initializer, section, and alignment:
696 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
698 The following example just declares a global variable
702 @G = external global i32
704 The following example defines a thread-local global with the
705 ``initialexec`` TLS model:
709 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
711 .. _functionstructure:
716 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
717 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`runtime preemption
718 specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
719 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
720 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
721 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
722 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
723 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
724 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
725 an optional address space, an optional section, an optional alignment,
726 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
727 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
728 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
729 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
730 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
731 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
733 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
734 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
735 <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
736 optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
737 or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, an optional address space, a return type,
738 an optional :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
739 empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
740 collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
741 :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
743 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
744 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
745 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
746 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
747 function return). If an explicit label name is not provided, a block is assigned
748 an implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used
749 for unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a
750 function entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label
751 "%0", then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc. If a
752 numeric label is explicitly specified, it must match the numeric label that
753 would be used implicitly.
755 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
756 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
757 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
758 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
759 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
761 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
762 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
763 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
765 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
766 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
767 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
768 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
769 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
771 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
772 be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
774 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
775 not be significant within the module.
777 If an explicit address space is not given, it will default to the program
778 address space from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
782 define [linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
784 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
785 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace] [fn Attrs]
786 [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
787 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
789 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
790 argument is of the following form:
794 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
802 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
803 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
805 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
808 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
809 :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional
810 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
811 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
815 @<Name> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
817 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
818 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
819 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
821 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
822 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
825 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
826 not be significant within the module.
828 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
829 some can only be checked when producing an object file:
831 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
832 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
834 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
835 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
838 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
839 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
846 IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
847 symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
849 IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
850 that returns address of another function associated with the name.
852 IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
853 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
857 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
865 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
867 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
868 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
869 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
870 aliasee computes to, if any.
872 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
873 choose between keys in two different object files.
877 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
879 The selection kind must be one of the following:
882 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
884 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
887 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
889 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
891 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
894 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs, and ELF and WebAssembly
895 only support ``any`` as a selection kind.
897 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
898 the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
902 $foo = comdat largest
903 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
905 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
909 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
915 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
918 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
919 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
920 and another COMDAT section with selection kind
921 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
922 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
924 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
925 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
927 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
928 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
929 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
930 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
931 if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
933 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
940 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
941 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
943 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
944 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
945 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
948 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
949 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
950 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
951 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
952 is supplied to `llc`).
954 .. _namedmetadatastructure:
959 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
960 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
961 operands for a named metadata.
963 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
964 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
965 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
966 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
970 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
975 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
982 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
983 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
984 used to communicate additional information about the result or
985 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
986 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
987 parameter attributes can have the same function type.
989 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
990 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
995 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
996 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
997 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
999 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
1000 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
1002 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
1005 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1006 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
1007 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
1009 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1010 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
1011 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
1012 the callee (for a return value).
1014 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
1015 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
1016 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
1017 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
1018 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
1020 ``byval`` or ``byval(<ty>)``
1021 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
1022 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
1023 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
1024 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
1025 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
1026 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
1027 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
1028 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
1029 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
1032 The byval attribute also supports an optional type argument, which must be
1033 the same as the pointee type of the argument.
1035 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
1036 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
1037 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
1038 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
1039 makes a target-specific assumption.
1045 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
1046 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
1047 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
1048 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
1049 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
1050 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
1052 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
1053 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
1054 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
1055 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
1056 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
1057 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
1058 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
1060 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1061 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
1062 behavior is undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
1063 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1064 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1065 <int_stackrestore>`.
1067 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1071 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1072 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1073 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
1074 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not
1075 to trap and to be properly aligned. This is not a valid attribute
1081 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1082 have the specified alignment. If the pointer value does not have the
1083 specified alignment, behavior is undefined.
1085 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1086 ``byval`` attribute, which are documented there.
1091 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1092 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1093 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1094 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1095 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1096 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1097 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1098 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
1100 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
1101 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
1103 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
1104 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1105 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1106 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1107 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1108 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1109 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1112 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1113 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
1114 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1115 are considered to be captured.
1120 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1121 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
1122 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1125 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
1126 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1127 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1128 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1129 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1130 function return type must be valid operands for the
1131 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1132 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1135 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1136 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1137 checked or enforced by LLVM; if the parameter or return pointer is null,
1138 the behavior is undefined.
1140 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1141 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1142 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1143 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1144 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1145 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1146 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1147 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1148 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1149 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1151 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1152 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1153 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
1154 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
1155 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1156 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1157 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1158 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1159 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1160 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
1161 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
1162 pointer typed parameters.
1165 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1166 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1170 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1171 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1172 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
1173 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca or
1174 the ``swifterror`` parameter of the caller. A ``swifterror`` value (either
1175 the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as
1176 a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values
1177 and can only be applied to one parameter.
1179 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1180 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1181 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1182 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1183 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1185 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1186 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1187 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1190 This indicates the parameter is required to be an immediate
1191 value. This must be a trivial immediate integer or floating-point
1192 constant. Undef or constant expressions are not valid. This is
1193 only valid on intrinsic declarations and cannot be applied to a
1194 call site or arbitrary function.
1198 Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1199 --------------------------------
1201 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
1204 .. code-block:: llvm
1206 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1208 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
1209 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
1210 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
1211 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
1212 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
1213 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
1220 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1221 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1222 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1223 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1224 available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1225 function pointer to be called.
1227 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1228 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
1229 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
1230 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1231 with a single ``i32``,
1233 .. code-block:: llvm
1235 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1237 The prefix data can be referenced as,
1239 .. code-block:: llvm
1241 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1242 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
1243 %b = load i32, i32* %a
1245 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
1246 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
1247 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1248 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1249 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1250 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1253 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
1254 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1255 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1262 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1263 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1264 function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1266 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
1267 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
1268 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1269 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
1270 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
1271 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
1272 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
1273 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
1275 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
1276 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1278 .. code-block:: text
1280 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
1282 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1283 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
1284 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1286 .. code-block:: text
1288 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1290 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
1292 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
1293 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1294 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1298 Personality Function
1299 --------------------
1301 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1302 to use for exception handling.
1309 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1310 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1311 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1312 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1313 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1315 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1316 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1317 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1318 different groups are merged.
1320 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1321 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1323 .. code-block:: llvm
1325 ; Target-independent attributes:
1326 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
1328 ; Target-dependent attributes:
1329 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
1331 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1332 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1339 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1340 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1341 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1342 attributes can have the same function type.
1344 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1345 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1348 .. code-block:: llvm
1350 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1351 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1352 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1353 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1356 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1357 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1358 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1360 ``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1361 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1362 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1363 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1364 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1365 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1366 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1367 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1368 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
1370 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1371 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1372 inlining size threshold for this caller.
1374 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1375 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
1376 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
1377 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
1380 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1381 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1382 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1385 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1386 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
1387 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
1389 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1390 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1391 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
1392 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
1393 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
1396 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1397 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1398 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1399 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1401 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1402 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1403 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1404 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
1405 ``inaccessiblememonly``
1406 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1407 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1408 of ``readnone``. If the function reads or writes other memory, the
1409 behavior is undefined.
1410 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1411 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1412 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1413 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``. If the
1414 function reads or writes other memory, the behavior is undefined.
1416 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1417 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1418 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1421 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1422 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1423 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1424 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1425 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1426 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1427 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
1429 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1430 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
1431 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
1432 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
1434 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1435 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
1437 When this attribute is set to true, the jump tables and lookup tables that
1438 can be generated from a switch case lowering are disabled.
1440 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1441 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1442 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1443 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1444 and on function declarations and definitions.
1446 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1447 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1448 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1449 its parent function.
1451 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1452 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1453 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1454 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1455 call is dead after inlining.
1457 This attributes disables implicit floating-point instructions.
1459 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1460 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1461 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
1463 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1464 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1465 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
1467 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1468 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1469 ``indirect-tls-seg-refs``
1470 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use
1471 direct TLS access through segment registers, even if the
1472 target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1474 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1475 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1476 function ever does dynamically return.
1478 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1479 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1480 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
1482 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1483 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1484 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1485 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1486 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1487 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
1488 ``"null-pointer-is-valid"``
1489 If ``"null-pointer-is-valid"`` is set to ``"true"``, then ``null`` address
1490 in address-space 0 is considered to be a valid address for memory loads and
1491 stores. Any analysis or optimization should not treat dereferencing a
1492 pointer to ``null`` as undefined behavior in this function.
1493 Note: Comparing address of a global variable to ``null`` may still
1494 evaluate to false because of a limitation in querying this attribute inside
1495 constant expressions.
1497 This attribute indicates that this function should be optimized
1498 for maximum fuzzing signal.
1500 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1501 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1502 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
1503 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1504 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1505 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
1507 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1508 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
1509 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
1510 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
1512 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1513 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
1514 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1515 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
1516 ``"patchable-function"``
1517 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1518 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1519 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1520 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
1521 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
1523 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1524 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1525 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1526 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1527 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1528 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1529 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1530 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1531 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1532 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1533 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1535 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1538 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1539 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1540 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
1542 This attribute indicates that the function will trigger a guard region
1543 in the end of the stack. It ensures that accesses to the stack must be
1544 no further apart than the size of the guard region to a previous
1545 access of the stack. It takes one required string value, the name of
1546 the stack probing function that will be called.
1548 If a function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into
1549 a function with another ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, the resulting
1550 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the caller. If a
1551 function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into a
1552 function that has no ``"probe-stack"`` attribute at all, the resulting
1553 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the callee.
1555 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1556 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
1557 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1558 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1559 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1560 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1561 to callers. This means while it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1562 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods (since they write to memory), there may
1563 be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw exceptions without writing to LLVM
1566 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1567 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
1568 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
1570 If a readnone function reads or writes memory visible to the program, or
1571 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads from
1572 or writes to a readnone pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1574 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1575 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
1576 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1577 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1578 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1579 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1580 called with the same set of arguments and global state. This means while it
1581 cannot unwind exceptions by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing methods
1582 (since they write to memory), there may be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw
1583 exceptions without writing to LLVM visible memory.
1585 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1586 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1587 the pointer points to.
1589 If a readonly function writes memory visible to the program, or
1590 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function writes to
1591 a readonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1592 ``"stack-probe-size"``
1593 This attribute controls the behavior of stack probes: either
1594 the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, or ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1595 It defines the size of the guard region. It ensures that if the function
1596 may use more stack space than the size of the guard region, stack probing
1597 sequence will be emitted. It takes one required integer value, which
1600 If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is inlined into
1601 a function with another ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute, the resulting
1602 function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute that has the lower
1603 numeric value. If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is
1604 inlined into a function that has no ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1605 at all, the resulting function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1607 ``"no-stack-arg-probe"``
1608 This attribute disables ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1610 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1611 does not read from memory.
1613 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1614 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1615 the memory that the pointer points to).
1617 If a writeonly function reads memory visible to the program, or
1618 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads
1619 from a writeonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1621 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1622 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1623 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1624 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1627 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1628 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
1630 If an argmemonly function reads or writes memory other than the pointer
1631 arguments, or has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined.
1633 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1634 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1635 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1638 This attribute indicates that
1639 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1640 protection is enabled for this function.
1642 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1643 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1644 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1645 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
1646 ``sanitize_address``
1647 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1648 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1650 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1651 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1653 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1654 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1655 ``sanitize_hwaddress``
1656 This attribute indicates that HWAddressSanitizer checks
1657 (dynamic address safety analysis based on tagged pointers) are enabled for
1659 ``speculative_load_hardening``
1660 This attribute indicates that
1661 `Speculative Load Hardening <https://llvm.org/docs/SpeculativeLoadHardening.html>`_
1662 should be enabled for the function body.
1664 Speculative Load Hardening is a best-effort mitigation against
1665 information leak attacks that make use of control flow
1666 miss-speculation - specifically miss-speculation of whether a branch
1667 is taken or not. Typically vulnerabilities enabling such attacks are
1668 classified as "Spectre variant #1". Notably, this does not attempt to
1669 mitigate against miss-speculation of branch target, classified as
1670 "Spectre variant #2" vulnerabilities.
1672 When inlining, the attribute is sticky. Inlining a function that carries
1673 this attribute will cause the caller to gain the attribute. This is intended
1674 to provide a maximally conservative model where the code in a function
1675 annotated with this attribute will always (even after inlining) end up
1678 This function attribute indicates that the function does not have any
1679 effects besides calculating its result and does not have undefined behavior.
1680 Note that ``speculatable`` is not enough to conclude that along any
1681 particular execution path the number of calls to this function will not be
1682 externally observable. This attribute is only valid on functions
1683 and declarations, not on individual call sites. If a function is
1684 incorrectly marked as speculatable and really does exhibit
1685 undefined behavior, the undefined behavior may be observed even
1686 if the call site is dead code.
1689 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
1690 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
1691 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1692 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1693 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
1694 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
1696 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1697 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1698 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1699 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1701 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1702 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1704 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1705 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1706 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1708 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1709 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1712 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1713 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1714 The specific layout rules are:
1716 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1717 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1718 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1719 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1720 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1723 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1724 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
1725 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1726 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1728 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
1729 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
1730 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
1731 will enable protectors for functions with:
1733 - Arrays of any size and type
1734 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1735 - Calls to alloca().
1736 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1738 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1739 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1740 The specific layout rules are:
1742 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1743 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1744 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1745 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1746 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1749 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
1751 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1752 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1753 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
1755 This attribute indicates that the function was called from a scope that
1756 requires strict floating-point semantics. LLVM will not attempt any
1757 optimizations that require assumptions about the floating-point rounding
1758 mode or that might alter the state of floating-point status flags that
1759 might otherwise be set or cleared by calling this function.
1761 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1762 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1763 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1764 match the thunk target prototype.
1766 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
1767 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
1768 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1769 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1772 This attribute indicates that no control-flow check will be performed on
1773 the attributed entity. It disables -fcf-protection=<> for a specific
1774 entity to fine grain the HW control flow protection mechanism. The flag
1775 is target independent and currently appertains to a function or function
1778 This attribute indicates that the ShadowCallStack checks are enabled for
1779 the function. The instrumentation checks that the return address for the
1780 function has not changed between the function prolog and eiplog. It is
1781 currently x86_64-specific.
1788 Attributes may be set to communicate additional information about a global variable.
1789 Unlike :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, attributes on a global variable
1790 are grouped into a single :ref:`attribute group <attrgrp>`.
1797 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
1798 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1799 ``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
1800 incorrect and will change program semantics.
1804 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
1805 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1806 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1807 tag ::= string constant
1809 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1810 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1811 of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1812 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1813 callee being dispatched to.
1815 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1816 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1817 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1818 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1819 bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1820 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1821 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1822 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1823 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1825 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1826 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1827 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1828 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
1829 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
1830 callsite specific attributes.
1831 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1832 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1833 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
1835 More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1837 .. _deopt_opbundles:
1839 Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1840 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1842 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
1843 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1844 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1845 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
1846 specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1847 bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1848 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1849 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
1851 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1852 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1853 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1854 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1855 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1856 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1859 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1860 operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1861 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1862 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1863 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1864 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1865 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1866 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1868 .. code-block:: llvm
1871 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1872 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1873 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1878 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1884 .. code-block:: llvm
1887 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1888 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1889 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1893 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1894 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1895 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1896 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1897 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1901 Funclet Operand Bundles
1902 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1904 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1905 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1906 is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1907 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1908 exactly one bundle operand.
1910 If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1911 `description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1912 it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1914 * does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1916 * has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1917 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1919 Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1920 executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1922 GC Transition Operand Bundles
1923 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1925 GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1926 ``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1927 call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1928 function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1929 between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1930 site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1931 generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1932 <gc_transition_args>`.
1936 Module-Level Inline Assembly
1937 ----------------------------
1939 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1940 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1941 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1942 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1944 .. code-block:: llvm
1946 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1947 module asm "more can go here"
1949 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1950 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1951 two digit hex code for the number.
1953 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1954 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
1956 .. _langref_datalayout:
1961 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1962 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1965 .. code-block:: llvm
1967 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1969 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1970 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1971 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1972 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1976 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1977 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1980 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1981 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1984 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1985 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1986 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1987 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1988 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1989 alignment promotions.
1990 ``P<address space>``
1991 Specifies the address space that corresponds to program memory.
1992 Harvard architectures can use this to specify what space LLVM
1993 should place things such as functions into. If omitted, the
1994 program memory space defaults to the default address space of 0,
1995 which corresponds to a Von Neumann architecture that has code
1996 and data in the same space.
1997 ``A<address space>``
1998 Specifies the address space of objects created by '``alloca``'.
1999 Defaults to the default address space of 0.
2000 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>:<idx>``
2001 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
2002 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. The fourth parameter
2003 ``<idx>`` is a size of index that used for address calculation. If not
2004 specified, the default index size is equal to the pointer size. All sizes
2005 are in bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
2006 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
2007 in the range [1,2^23).
2008 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2009 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
2010 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
2011 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2012 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
2014 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
2015 This specifies the alignment for a floating-point type of a given bit
2016 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
2017 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
2018 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
2021 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
2023 This specifies the alignment for function pointers.
2024 The options for ``<type>`` are:
2026 * ``i``: The alignment of function pointers is independent of the alignment
2027 of functions, and is a multiple of ``<abi>``.
2028 * ``n``: The alignment of function pointers is a multiple of the explicit
2029 alignment specified on the function, and is a multiple of ``<abi>``.
2031 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. Symbols
2032 prefixed with the mangling escape character ``\01`` are passed through
2033 directly to the assembler without the escape character. The mangling style
2036 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
2037 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
2038 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
2039 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
2040 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF mangling: Private symbols get the usual prefix.
2041 Regular C symbols get a ``_`` prefix. Functions with ``__stdcall``,
2042 ``__fastcall``, and ``__vectorcall`` have custom mangling that appends
2043 ``@N`` where N is the number of bytes used to pass parameters. C++ symbols
2044 starting with ``?`` are not mangled in any way.
2045 * ``w``: Windows COFF mangling: Similar to ``x``, except that normal C
2046 symbols do not receive a ``_`` prefix.
2047 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
2048 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
2049 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
2050 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
2051 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
2053 ``ni:<address space0>:<address space1>:<address space2>...``
2054 This specifies pointer types with the specified address spaces
2055 as :ref:`Non-Integral Pointer Type <nointptrtype>` s. The ``0``
2056 address space cannot be specified as non-integral.
2058 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
2059 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
2060 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
2062 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
2063 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
2064 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
2065 specifications are given in this list:
2067 - ``E`` - big endian
2068 - ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
2069 - ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
2070 same as the default address space.
2071 - ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
2072 - ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2073 - ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2074 - ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
2075 - ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
2076 - ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
2077 alignment of 64-bits
2078 - ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
2079 - ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
2080 - ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
2081 - ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
2082 - ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
2083 - ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
2084 - ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
2086 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
2089 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
2090 that specification is used.
2091 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
2092 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
2093 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
2094 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
2095 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
2096 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
2097 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
2098 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
2099 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
2100 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
2101 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
2103 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
2104 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
2105 the code generator should use.
2107 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
2108 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
2109 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
2110 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
2111 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
2112 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
2113 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
2114 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
2115 these default specifications.
2122 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
2123 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
2125 .. code-block:: llvm
2127 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
2129 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
2130 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
2134 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
2135 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
2137 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
2138 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
2139 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
2141 .. _pointeraliasing:
2143 Pointer Aliasing Rules
2144 ----------------------
2146 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
2147 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
2148 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
2149 to the following rules:
2151 - A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
2152 value it is *based* on.
2153 - An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
2154 of the variable's storage.
2155 - The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
2156 address range of the allocated storage.
2157 - A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
2159 - An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
2160 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
2161 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
2162 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
2163 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
2165 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
2168 - A pointer value formed from a scalar ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* on
2169 the pointer-typed operand of the ``getelementptr``.
2170 - The pointer in lane *l* of the result of a vector ``getelementptr`` operation
2171 is *based* on the pointer in lane *l* of the vector-of-pointers-typed operand
2172 of the ``getelementptr``.
2173 - The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
2175 - A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
2176 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
2177 the pointer's value.
2178 - The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
2180 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
2181 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
2183 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
2184 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
2185 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
2186 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
2187 alignment of the store.
2189 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
2190 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
2191 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
2192 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
2197 Volatile Memory Accesses
2198 ------------------------
2200 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
2201 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
2202 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
2203 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
2204 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
2205 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
2206 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
2208 A volatile load or store may have additional target-specific semantics.
2209 Any volatile operation can have side effects, and any volatile operation
2210 can read and/or modify state which is not accessible via a regular load
2211 or store in this module. Volatile operations may use addresses which do
2212 not point to memory (like MMIO registers). This means the compiler may
2213 not use a volatile operation to prove a non-volatile access to that
2214 address has defined behavior.
2216 The allowed side-effects for volatile accesses are limited. If a
2217 non-volatile store to a given address would be legal, a volatile
2218 operation may modify the memory at that address. A volatile operation
2219 may not modify any other memory accessible by the module being compiled.
2220 A volatile operation may not call any code in the current module.
2222 The compiler may assume execution will continue after a volatile operation,
2223 so operations which modify memory or may have undefined behavior can be
2224 hoisted past a volatile operation.
2226 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
2227 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
2228 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
2229 target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
2231 .. admonition:: Rationale
2233 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
2234 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
2235 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
2236 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
2237 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
2238 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
2239 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
2243 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2244 --------------------------------------
2246 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2247 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2248 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2249 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2251 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2253 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2256 - Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2257 - When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2258 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2259 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2260 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2261 Constraints <ordering>`).
2263 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2264 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2266 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2267 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2268 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2269 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2270 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2271 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2272 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2273 may see any write to the same byte, except:
2275 - If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2276 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2277 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2278 - If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2279 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2281 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2283 - If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2284 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
2285 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
2286 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2288 - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2289 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2290 - Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2291 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2292 - Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2293 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2294 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2295 constraints on how the choice is made.
2296 - Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2298 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2299 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2300 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2301 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2302 than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2304 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2305 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2306 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2307 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2308 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2309 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2310 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2314 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2315 ----------------------------------
2317 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2318 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2319 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
2320 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
2321 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2322 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2323 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2324 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2325 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2326 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2327 documentation for details.
2329 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2333 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2334 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2335 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2336 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2337 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2338 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2340 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2341 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2342 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2343 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2344 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2345 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2346 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2347 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2348 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2349 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2350 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2351 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2352 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2353 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2354 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2355 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2356 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2358 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2359 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2360 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2362 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2363 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2364 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2365 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2366 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2367 ``memory_order_release``.
2368 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2369 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2370 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2371 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2372 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
2373 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
2374 writes), there is a global total order on all
2375 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2376 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2377 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2378 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2379 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2380 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2384 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``, it only
2385 *synchronizes with* and only participates in the seq\_cst total orderings of
2386 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal handlers).
2388 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``, where
2389 ``<target-scope>`` is a target specific synchronization scope, then it is target
2390 dependent if it *synchronizes with* and participates in the seq\_cst total
2391 orderings of other operations.
2393 Otherwise, an atomic operation that is not marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``
2394 or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` *synchronizes with* and participates in the
2395 seq\_cst total orderings of other operations that are not marked
2396 ``syncscope("singlethread")`` or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``.
2400 Floating-Point Environment
2401 --------------------------
2403 The default LLVM floating-point environment assumes that floating-point
2404 instructions do not have side effects. Results assume the round-to-nearest
2405 rounding mode. No floating-point exception state is maintained in this
2406 environment. Therefore, there is no attempt to create or preserve invalid
2407 operation (SNaN) or division-by-zero exceptions.
2409 The benefit of this exception-free assumption is that floating-point
2410 operations may be speculated freely without any other fast-math relaxations
2411 to the floating-point model.
2413 Code that requires different behavior than this should use the
2414 :ref:`Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics <constrainedfp>`.
2421 LLVM IR floating-point operations (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
2422 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
2423 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) and :ref:`call <i_call>`
2424 may use the following flags to enable otherwise unsafe
2425 floating-point transformations.
2428 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2429 NaN. If an argument is a nan, or the result would be a nan, it produces
2430 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2433 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2434 +/-Inf. If an argument is +/-Inf, or the result would be +/-Inf, it
2435 produces a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2438 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2439 argument or result as insignificant.
2442 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2443 argument rather than perform division.
2446 Allow floating-point contraction (e.g. fusing a multiply followed by an
2447 addition into a fused multiply-and-add).
2450 Approximate functions - Allow substitution of approximate calculations for
2451 functions (sin, log, sqrt, etc). See floating-point intrinsic definitions
2452 for places where this can apply to LLVM's intrinsic math functions.
2455 Allow reassociation transformations for floating-point instructions.
2456 This may dramatically change results in floating-point.
2459 This flag implies all of the others.
2463 Use-list Order Directives
2464 -------------------------
2466 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
2467 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2468 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
2469 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2471 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2472 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
2473 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2475 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2476 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2483 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2484 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2490 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2492 ; ... instructions ...
2494 ; ... instructions ...
2496 ; At function scope.
2497 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2498 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2502 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2503 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2504 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2505 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2507 .. _source_filename:
2512 The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2513 which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2514 source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2517 This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2518 identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2519 source file name to the local function name.
2521 The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2523 .. code-block:: text
2525 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2532 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2533 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2534 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2535 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2536 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2537 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2538 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2548 The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2566 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2567 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2568 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2569 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
2575 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
2577 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2578 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
2579 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
2580 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
2581 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
2582 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
2586 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2587 | ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2588 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2589 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2590 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2591 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2592 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2593 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2594 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2601 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2602 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2610 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
2619 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2620 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2621 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2629 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2635 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2636 | ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2637 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2638 | ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2639 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2640 | ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2641 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2645 Floating-Point Types
2646 """"""""""""""""""""
2655 - 16-bit floating-point value
2658 - 32-bit floating-point value
2661 - 64-bit floating-point value
2664 - 128-bit floating-point value (112-bit mantissa)
2667 - 80-bit floating-point value (X87)
2670 - 128-bit floating-point value (two 64-bits)
2672 The binary format of half, float, double, and fp128 correspond to the
2673 IEEE-754-2008 specifications for binary16, binary32, binary64, and binary128
2681 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
2682 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2683 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2684 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2685 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2702 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2703 commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2705 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2706 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2707 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2708 are target-specific.
2710 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2711 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
2721 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2722 | ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2723 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2724 | ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2725 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2726 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2727 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2736 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2737 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2738 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2739 requires a size (number of elements), an underlying primitive data type,
2740 and a scalable property to represent vectors where the exact hardware
2741 vector length is unknown at compile time. Vector types are considered
2742 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2748 < <# elements> x <elementtype> > ; Fixed-length vector
2749 < vscale x <# elements> x <elementtype> > ; Scalable vector
2751 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
2752 elementtype may be any integer, floating-point or pointer type. Vectors
2753 of size zero are not allowed. For scalable vectors, the total number of
2754 elements is a constant multiple (called vscale) of the specified number
2755 of elements; vscale is a positive integer that is unknown at compile time
2756 and the same hardware-dependent constant for all scalable vectors at run
2757 time. The size of a specific scalable vector type is thus constant within
2758 IR, even if the exact size in bytes cannot be determined until run time.
2762 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2763 | ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2764 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2765 | ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2766 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2767 | ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2768 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2769 | ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2770 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2771 | ``<vscale x 4 x i32>`` | Vector with a multiple of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2772 +------------------------+----------------------------------------------------+
2781 The label type represents code labels.
2796 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2797 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2798 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2799 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2816 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2817 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2830 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2831 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2832 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2842 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2843 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2844 elements) and an underlying data type.
2850 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2852 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2853 be any type with a size.
2857 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2858 | ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2859 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2860 | ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2861 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2862 | ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2863 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2865 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2867 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2868 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2869 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2870 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating-point values. |
2871 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2872 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2873 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2875 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2876 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2877 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2878 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2879 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2880 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2890 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2891 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2894 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2895 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2896 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2897 '``insertvalue``' instructions.
2899 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2900 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2901 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2902 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2903 required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2905 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2906 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2907 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2908 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2909 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2910 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2916 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2917 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2921 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2922 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2923 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2924 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
2925 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2926 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2927 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2931 Opaque Structure Types
2932 """"""""""""""""""""""
2936 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2937 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2938 notion of a forward declared structure.
2949 +--------------+-------------------+
2950 | ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2951 +--------------+-------------------+
2958 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2959 describes them all and their syntax.
2964 **Boolean constants**
2965 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2967 **Integer constants**
2968 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2969 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2971 **Floating-point constants**
2972 Floating-point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2973 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2974 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2975 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2976 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2977 decimal in binary. Floating-point constants must have a
2978 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type.
2979 **Null pointer constants**
2980 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2981 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
2983 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2984 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
2986 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2987 floating-point constants. For example, the form
2988 '``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2989 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating-point
2990 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2991 disassembler) is when a floating-point constant must be emitted but it
2992 cannot be represented as a decimal floating-point number in a reasonable
2993 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2994 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2995 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2997 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2998 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2999 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
3000 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
3001 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
3002 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
3003 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
3004 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
3005 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
3006 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
3007 will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
3008 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
3009 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
3010 (sign bit at the left).
3012 There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
3014 .. _complexconstants:
3019 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
3020 constants and smaller complex constants.
3022 **Structure constants**
3023 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
3024 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
3025 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
3026 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
3027 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
3028 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
3029 must match those specified by the type.
3031 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
3032 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
3033 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
3034 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
3035 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
3036 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
3037 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
3038 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
3039 **Vector constants**
3040 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
3041 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
3042 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
3043 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
3044 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
3045 elements must match those specified by the type.
3046 **Zero initialization**
3047 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
3048 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
3049 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
3050 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
3051 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
3053 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
3054 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
3055 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
3056 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
3057 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
3058 information such as debug info.
3060 Global Variable and Function Addresses
3061 --------------------------------------
3063 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
3064 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
3065 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
3066 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
3067 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
3070 .. code-block:: llvm
3074 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
3081 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
3082 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
3083 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
3084 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
3086 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
3087 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
3088 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
3089 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
3091 .. code-block:: llvm
3101 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
3102 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
3104 .. code-block:: llvm
3112 %A = %X ;; By choosing undef as 0
3113 %B = %X ;; By choosing undef as -1
3118 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
3119 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
3120 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
3121 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
3122 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
3123 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
3124 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
3125 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
3126 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
3128 .. code-block:: llvm
3130 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
3131 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
3132 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
3142 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
3143 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
3144 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
3145 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
3146 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
3147 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
3148 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
3150 .. code-block:: text
3152 %A = xor undef, undef
3169 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
3170 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
3171 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
3172 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
3173 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
3174 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
3175 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
3176 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
3177 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
3178 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
3179 uses with" concept would not hold.
3181 .. code-block:: llvm
3189 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
3190 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
3191 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
3192 operation can be constant folded to '``0``', because the '``undef``'
3193 could be zero, and zero divided by any value is zero.
3194 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
3195 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
3196 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
3197 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
3198 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
3199 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
3200 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
3202 .. code-block:: text
3204 a: store undef -> %X
3205 b: store %X -> undef
3210 A store *of* an undefined value can be assumed to not have any effect;
3211 we can assume that the value is overwritten with bits that happen to
3212 match what was already there. However, a store *to* an undefined
3213 location could clobber arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined
3221 Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
3222 they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
3223 that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
3224 that results in undefined behavior.
3226 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
3227 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
3230 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
3232 - Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
3233 - :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
3234 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
3235 - Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
3236 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
3237 - :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
3238 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3239 - :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
3240 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
3241 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3242 - Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
3243 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
3244 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
3245 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
3246 - An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
3247 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
3248 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
3249 operations <volatile>`.)
3250 - An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
3251 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
3252 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
3253 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
3254 when control is transferred to another.
3255 - Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
3256 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
3257 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
3259 - Dependence is transitive.
3261 Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
3262 with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
3263 on a poison value has undefined behavior.
3265 Here are some examples:
3267 .. code-block:: llvm
3270 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
3271 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
3272 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
3273 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
3275 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
3276 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
3278 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
3280 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
3281 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
3282 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3283 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3285 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
3286 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
3289 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
3290 ; it has undefined behavior.
3294 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
3295 ; Both edges into this PHI are
3296 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
3297 ; always results in a poison value.
3299 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3300 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3301 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3303 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3304 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3305 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3312 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3313 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3314 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3315 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3316 ; behavior in this example).
3320 Addresses of Basic Blocks
3321 -------------------------
3323 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3325 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3326 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3327 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3329 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3330 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' or ':ref:`callbr <i_callbr>`'instruction, or
3331 for comparisons against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses
3332 results in undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok,
3333 and no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3334 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3335 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3336 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr`` or
3337 ``callbr`` instruction.
3339 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3340 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3344 Constant Expressions
3345 --------------------
3347 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3348 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3349 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3350 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3351 The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3353 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
3354 Perform the :ref:`trunc operation <i_trunc>` on constants.
3355 ``zext (CST to TYPE)``
3356 Perform the :ref:`zext operation <i_zext>` on constants.
3357 ``sext (CST to TYPE)``
3358 Perform the :ref:`sext operation <i_sext>` on constants.
3359 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
3360 Truncate a floating-point constant to another floating-point type.
3361 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
3362 must be floating-point.
3363 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
3364 Floating-point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
3365 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
3367 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
3368 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding unsigned
3369 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3370 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3371 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3372 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3373 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3374 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
3375 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding signed
3376 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3377 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3378 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3379 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3380 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3381 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3382 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding
3383 floating-point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point
3384 type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3385 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3386 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3387 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating-point
3388 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point type.
3389 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3390 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3391 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
3392 Perform the :ref:`ptrtoint operation <i_ptrtoint>` on constants.
3393 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
3394 Perform the :ref:`inttoptr operation <i_inttoptr>` on constants.
3395 This one is *really* dangerous!
3396 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
3397 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE.
3398 The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the
3399 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`.
3400 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3401 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3402 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3403 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
3404 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3405 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3406 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
3407 instruction, the index list may have one or more indexes, which are
3408 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
3409 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3410 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3411 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3412 Perform the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
3413 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3414 Perform the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
3415 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3416 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3418 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3419 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3421 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3422 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3424 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3425 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3426 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3427 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3428 least one index value must be specified.
3429 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3430 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3431 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3432 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3433 value must be specified.
3434 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3435 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3436 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3437 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3438 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
3439 operations on floating-point values are allowed).
3446 Inline Assembler Expressions
3447 ----------------------------
3449 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
3450 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3451 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3452 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3453 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3454 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3455 stack conservatively.
3457 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3458 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3459 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3460 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3461 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3463 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3464 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3465 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3466 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3467 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3468 syntax known to LLVM.
3470 LLVM also supports a few more substitions useful for writing inline assembly:
3472 - ``${:uid}``: Expands to a decimal integer unique to this inline assembly blob.
3473 This substitution is useful when declaring a local label. Many standard
3474 compiler optimizations, such as inlining, may duplicate an inline asm blob.
3475 Adding a blob-unique identifier ensures that the two labels will not conflict
3476 during assembly. This is used to implement `GCC's %= special format
3477 string <https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Extended-Asm.html>`_.
3478 - ``${:comment}``: Expands to the comment character of the current target's
3479 assembly dialect. This is usually ``#``, but many targets use other strings,
3480 such as ``;``, ``//``, or ``!``.
3481 - ``${:private}``: Expands to the assembler private label prefix. Labels with
3482 this prefix will not appear in the symbol table of the assembled object.
3483 Typically the prefix is ``L``, but targets may use other strings. ``.L`` is
3486 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3487 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3488 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3489 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3490 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3491 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3492 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3495 An example inline assembler expression is:
3497 .. code-block:: llvm
3499 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3501 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3502 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3503 Thus, typically we have:
3505 .. code-block:: llvm
3507 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3509 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3510 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3511 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3513 .. code-block:: llvm
3515 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3517 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3518 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3519 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3520 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3521 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3522 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3524 .. code-block:: llvm
3526 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3528 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3529 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3530 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3531 the only supported dialects. An example is:
3533 .. code-block:: llvm
3535 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3537 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3538 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3541 Inline Asm Constraint String
3542 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3544 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3545 more constraint codes.
3547 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3548 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3549 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3552 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3553 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3554 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3555 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3557 There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3559 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3560 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3561 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3562 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3563 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3564 modes used by the target.
3565 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3566 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3567 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3568 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3573 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3574 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3575 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3576 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3577 below about indirect outputs).
3579 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3580 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3581 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3582 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3583 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3584 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
3585 "early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
3586 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3592 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3593 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3594 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3595 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3596 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3597 contain the same value.
3599 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3600 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3601 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3602 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3603 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3604 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3605 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3608 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3609 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3610 (even when the other input has the same value).
3612 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3613 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3615 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3616 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3617 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3618 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3620 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3622 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3623 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3624 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3625 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3626 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3627 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3629 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3630 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3631 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3632 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3633 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3634 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3635 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3638 Indirect inputs and outputs
3639 """""""""""""""""""""""""""
3641 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3642 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3643 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3644 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3645 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3646 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3647 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3648 memory location, instead of just read from it).
3650 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3651 address of a variable as a value.
3653 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3654 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3655 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3656 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3657 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3658 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3659 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3665 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3666 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3667 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3668 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3669 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3670 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3673 Note that clobbering named registers that are also present in output
3674 constraints is not legal.
3679 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3681 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3682 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3685 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3686 GCC's constraint codes.
3688 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3689 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3690 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3692 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3693 inline asm constraint list:
3695 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3696 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3697 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3700 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3701 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3702 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3703 constraint list will be chosen together.
3705 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3706 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3707 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3708 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3710 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3711 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3712 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3713 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3714 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3715 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3716 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3717 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3718 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3719 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3722 Supported Constraint Code List
3723 """"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3725 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3726 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3727 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3728 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3730 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3732 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3733 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3734 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3735 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3736 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3737 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3738 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3739 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3740 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3741 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3743 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3744 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3746 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3748 Other constraints are target-specific:
3752 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3753 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3754 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3755 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3756 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3757 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3758 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3759 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3760 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3761 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3762 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3763 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3764 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3765 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3766 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3767 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3768 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3770 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3771 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3772 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3776 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3777 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3778 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3783 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3784 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3786 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3788 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3789 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3790 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3791 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3792 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3793 print the inverted value).
3794 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3795 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3797 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3798 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3799 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3800 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3801 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3803 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3805 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3806 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3807 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3808 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3809 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3814 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3815 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3816 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3818 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3819 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3820 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3821 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3822 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3823 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3824 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3825 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3826 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3827 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3828 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3829 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3835 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3837 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3841 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3845 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3846 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3847 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3848 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3849 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3850 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3851 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3852 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3853 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3854 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3855 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3857 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3858 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3859 - ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3860 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
3861 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3862 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
3863 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3865 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3870 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3871 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3872 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3873 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3874 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3875 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3880 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3881 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3882 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3883 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3884 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3885 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3886 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3887 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3889 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3890 treated the same as ``m``.
3891 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3892 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3894 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3895 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3896 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3897 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3898 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3900 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3901 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3903 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3904 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3905 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3906 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3907 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating-point register, from the full VSX register
3912 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3913 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3914 - ``f``: Any floating-point register on SparcV8, or a floating-point
3915 register in the "low" half of the registers on SparcV9.
3916 - ``e``: Any floating-point register. (Same as ``f`` on SparcV8.)
3920 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3921 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3922 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3923 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3924 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3925 - ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3926 unsigned displacement.
3927 - ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3928 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3929 - ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3930 signed displacement.
3931 - ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3932 signed displacement, and an index register.
3933 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3934 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3935 address context evaluates as zero).
3936 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3938 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point register.
3942 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3943 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3944 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3945 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3947 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3948 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3949 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3950 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3951 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3952 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3953 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3954 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3955 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3956 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3957 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3958 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3959 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3960 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3961 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3962 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3963 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3964 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3965 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3966 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3967 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3968 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3969 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3970 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3971 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3972 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3977 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3980 .. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3982 Asm template argument modifiers
3983 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3985 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3988 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3989 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3990 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3991 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3995 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
3996 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3997 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3998 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3999 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
4000 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
4004 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
4005 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
4006 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
4007 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
4008 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
4017 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
4021 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
4022 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
4023 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
4025 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
4026 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
4027 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
4028 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
4029 register of a two-register operand.
4030 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
4031 register of a two-register operand.
4032 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
4033 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
4036 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
4037 of a two-register operand.
4039 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4040 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4041 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
4046 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4047 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4049 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4050 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4052 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4053 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4057 No additional modifiers.
4061 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
4062 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
4063 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
4064 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
4065 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
4066 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4067 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4069 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
4071 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4072 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4074 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
4076 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4077 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
4078 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
4080 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
4081 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
4090 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4091 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4093 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4094 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4096 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4097 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4098 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
4099 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
4100 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
4101 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
4102 always print nothing)
4103 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
4104 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
4112 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
4113 target-independent modifiers.
4117 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
4118 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
4119 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
4120 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
4122 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
4124 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
4126 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
4128 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
4129 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
4130 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
4131 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
4132 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
4133 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
4134 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
4135 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
4136 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
4140 No additional modifiers.
4146 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
4147 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
4148 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
4149 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
4150 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
4151 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
4154 .. code-block:: llvm
4156 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
4158 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
4160 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
4161 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
4162 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
4170 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
4171 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
4172 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
4173 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
4175 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
4176 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
4178 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
4180 .. _metadata-string:
4182 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
4183 -----------------------------------
4185 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
4186 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
4187 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
4190 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
4191 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
4192 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
4193 their operand. For example:
4195 .. code-block:: llvm
4197 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
4199 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
4201 .. code-block:: text
4203 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
4205 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
4206 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
4207 when metadata operands change.
4209 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
4210 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
4213 .. code-block:: llvm
4217 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here the ``llvm.dbg.value``
4218 intrinsic is using three metadata arguments:
4220 .. code-block:: llvm
4222 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, metadata !25, metadata !26)
4224 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
4225 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4227 .. code-block:: llvm
4229 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
4231 Metadata can also be attached to a function or a global variable. Here metadata
4232 ``!22`` is attached to the ``f1`` and ``f2 functions, and the globals ``g1``
4233 and ``g2`` using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4235 .. code-block:: llvm
4237 declare !dbg !22 void @f1()
4238 define void @f2() !dbg !22 {
4242 @g1 = global i32 0, !dbg !22
4243 @g2 = external global i32, !dbg !22
4245 A transformation is required to drop any metadata attachment that it does not
4246 know or know it can't preserve. Currently there is an exception for metadata
4247 attachment to globals for ``!type`` and ``!absolute_symbol`` which can't be
4248 unconditionally dropped unless the global is itself deleted.
4250 Metadata attached to a module using named metadata may not be dropped, with
4251 the exception of debug metadata (named metadata with the name ``!llvm.dbg.*``).
4253 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
4254 optimizers and code generator is found below.
4256 .. _specialized-metadata:
4258 Specialized Metadata Nodes
4259 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4261 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
4262 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
4265 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
4266 metadata nodes are related to debug info.
4273 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
4274 ``retainedTypes:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` fields are tuples
4275 containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit, regardless
4276 of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are references to
4277 them from instructions). The ``debugInfoForProfiling:`` field is a boolean
4278 indicating whether or not line-table discriminators are updated to provide
4279 more-accurate debug info for profiling results.
4281 .. code-block:: text
4283 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
4284 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
4285 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
4286 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, globals: !4, imports: !5,
4287 macros: !6, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
4289 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
4290 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. These
4291 descriptors are collected by a named metadata node ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They keep
4292 track of global variables, type information, and imported entities (declarations
4300 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
4302 .. code-block:: none
4304 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir",
4305 checksumkind: CSK_MD5,
4306 checksum: "000102030405060708090a0b0c0d0e0f")
4308 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
4309 for ``file:`` fields.
4310 Valid values for ``checksumkind:`` field are: {CSK_None, CSK_MD5, CSK_SHA1}
4317 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
4318 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
4320 .. code-block:: text
4322 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4323 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4324 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
4326 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
4329 .. code-block:: text
4335 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4337 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4339 .. _DISubroutineType:
4344 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
4345 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
4346 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
4347 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4349 .. code-block:: text
4351 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4352 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
4353 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
4360 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
4363 .. code-block:: text
4365 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4366 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4367 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
4370 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4372 .. code-block:: text
4375 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4376 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4378 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
4379 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4380 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
4382 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4383 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
4384 DW_TAG_atomic_type = 71
4386 .. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4388 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
4389 <DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
4390 ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4391 ``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4392 uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
4394 ``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4395 field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4398 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4400 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
4401 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type``, ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` and ``DW_TAG_atomic_type``
4402 are used to qualify the ``baseType:``.
4404 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4406 .. _DICompositeType:
4411 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
4412 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
4414 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
4415 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4416 :ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4417 derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4418 ``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
4420 For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4421 does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4422 together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4423 field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4425 .. code-block:: text
4427 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4428 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4429 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4430 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
4431 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4432 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4434 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4436 .. code-block:: text
4438 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4439 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4440 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4441 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4442 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
4444 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
4445 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
4446 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
4447 array type is a native packed vector.
4449 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
4450 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
4451 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
4452 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4454 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4455 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
4456 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4457 ``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4458 ``isDefinition: false``.
4465 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
4466 :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4468 - ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
4469 - ``count: !9`` describes the count with a :ref:`DILocalVariable`.
4470 - ``count: !11`` describes the count with a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable`.
4472 .. code-block:: text
4474 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4475 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4476 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
4478 ; Scopes used in rest of example
4479 !6 = !DIFile(filename: "vla.c", directory: "/path/to/file")
4480 !7 = distinct !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !6)
4481 !8 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", scope: !7, file: !6, line: 5)
4483 ; Use of local variable as count value
4484 !9 = !DIBasicType(name: "int", size: 32, encoding: DW_ATE_signed)
4485 !10 = !DILocalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 42, type: !9)
4486 !11 = !DISubrange(count: !10, lowerBound: 0)
4488 ; Use of global variable as count value
4489 !12 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 22, type: !9)
4490 !13 = !DISubrange(count: !12, lowerBound: 0)
4497 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4498 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4500 .. code-block:: text
4502 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4503 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4504 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4506 DITemplateTypeParameter
4507 """""""""""""""""""""""
4509 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
4510 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
4511 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4513 .. code-block:: text
4515 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
4517 DITemplateValueParameter
4518 """"""""""""""""""""""""
4520 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
4521 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
4522 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
4523 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
4524 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4526 .. code-block:: text
4528 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
4533 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
4535 .. code-block:: text
4537 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
4539 .. _DIGlobalVariable:
4544 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
4546 .. code-block:: text
4548 @foo = global i32, !dbg !0
4549 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(var: !1, expr: !DIExpression())
4550 !1 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !2,
4551 file: !3, line: 7, type: !4, isLocal: true,
4552 isDefinition: false, declaration: !5)
4555 DIGlobalVariableExpression
4556 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
4558 ``DIGlobalVariableExpression`` nodes tie a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable` together
4559 with a :ref:`DIExpression`.
4561 .. code-block:: text
4563 @lower = global i32, !dbg !0
4564 @upper = global i32, !dbg !1
4565 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4567 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 0, 32)
4569 !1 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4571 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 32, 32)
4573 !2 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "split64", linkageName: "split64", scope: !3,
4574 file: !4, line: 8, type: !5, declaration: !6)
4576 All global variable expressions should be referenced by the `globals:` field of
4577 a :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4584 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4585 ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4586 metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4587 that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4588 the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
4590 .. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4592 When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
4593 tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4594 type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4595 then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4598 .. code-block:: text
4600 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4604 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4605 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4606 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
4608 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4609 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4610 isOptimized: true, unit: !5, templateParams: !6,
4611 declaration: !7, variables: !8, thrownTypes: !9)
4618 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
4619 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
4620 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
4623 .. code-block:: text
4625 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
4627 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4630 .. _DILexicalBlockFile:
4635 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
4636 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
4637 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4638 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4640 .. code-block:: text
4642 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4643 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4644 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
4651 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
4652 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4653 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4655 .. code-block:: text
4657 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
4659 .. _DILocalVariable:
4664 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
4665 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4666 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4667 :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4669 .. code-block:: text
4671 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4672 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4673 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4675 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
4682 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent expressions that are inspired by the DWARF
4683 expression language. They are used in :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>`
4684 (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare`` and ``llvm.dbg.value``) to describe how the
4685 referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language variable. Debug
4686 intrinsics are interpreted left-to-right: start by pushing the value/address
4687 operand of the intrinsic onto a stack, then repeatedly push and evaluate
4688 opcodes from the DIExpression until the final variable description is produced.
4690 The current supported opcode vocabulary is limited:
4692 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the top of the expression stack.
4693 - ``DW_OP_plus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, adds
4694 them together and appends the result to the expression stack.
4695 - ``DW_OP_minus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, subtracts
4696 the last entry from the second last entry and appends the result to the
4698 - ``DW_OP_plus_uconst, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4699 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4700 here, respectively) of the variable fragment from the working expression. Note
4701 that contrary to DW_OP_bit_piece, the offset is describing the location
4702 within the described source variable.
4703 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_convert, 16, DW_ATE_signed`` specifies a bit size and encoding
4704 (``16`` and ``DW_ATE_signed`` here, respectively) to which the top of the
4705 expression stack is to be converted. Maps into a ``DW_OP_convert`` operation
4706 that references a base type constructed from the supplied values.
4707 - ``DW_OP_swap`` swaps top two stack entries.
4708 - ``DW_OP_xderef`` provides extended dereference mechanism. The entry at the top
4709 of the stack is treated as an address. The second stack entry is treated as an
4710 address space identifier.
4711 - ``DW_OP_stack_value`` marks a constant value.
4713 DWARF specifies three kinds of simple location descriptions: Register, memory,
4714 and implicit location descriptions. Note that a location description is
4715 defined over certain ranges of a program, i.e the location of a variable may
4716 change over the course of the program. Register and memory location
4717 descriptions describe the *concrete location* of a source variable (in the
4718 sense that a debugger might modify its value), whereas *implicit locations*
4719 describe merely the actual *value* of a source variable which might not exist
4720 in registers or in memory (see ``DW_OP_stack_value``).
4722 A ``llvm.dbg.addr`` or ``llvm.dbg.declare`` intrinsic describes an indirect
4723 value (the address) of a source variable. The first operand of the intrinsic
4724 must be an address of some kind. A DIExpression attached to the intrinsic
4725 refines this address to produce a concrete location for the source variable.
4727 A ``llvm.dbg.value`` intrinsic describes the direct value of a source variable.
4728 The first operand of the intrinsic may be a direct or indirect value. A
4729 DIExpresion attached to the intrinsic refines the first operand to produce a
4730 direct value. For example, if the first operand is an indirect value, it may be
4731 necessary to insert ``DW_OP_deref`` into the DIExpresion in order to produce a
4732 valid debug intrinsic.
4736 A DIExpression is interpreted in the same way regardless of which kind of
4737 debug intrinsic it's attached to.
4739 .. code-block:: text
4741 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4742 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus_uconst, 3)
4743 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus)
4744 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4745 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus, DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 3, 7)
4746 !4 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 2, DW_OP_swap, DW_OP_xderef)
4747 !5 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 42, DW_OP_stack_value)
4752 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
4754 .. code-block:: text
4756 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
4757 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4762 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
4765 .. code-block:: text
4767 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
4768 entity: !1, line: 7)
4773 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4774 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
4775 defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
4776 used to expand the macro identifier.
4778 .. code-block:: text
4780 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4782 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4787 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4788 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4789 appear in the included source file.
4791 .. code-block:: text
4793 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4799 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4800 suitable for doing type based alias analysis (TBAA). Instead, metadata is
4801 added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This
4802 can be used to implement C/C++ strict type aliasing rules, but it can also
4803 be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4805 This description of LLVM's TBAA system is broken into two parts:
4806 :ref:`Semantics<tbaa_node_semantics>` talks about high level issues, and
4807 :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` talks about the metadata
4808 encoding of various entities.
4810 It is always possible to trace any TBAA node to a "root" TBAA node (details
4811 in the :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` section). TBAA
4812 nodes with different roots have an unknown aliasing relationship, and LLVM
4813 conservatively infers ``MayAlias`` between them. The rules mentioned in
4814 this section only pertain to TBAA nodes living under the same root.
4816 .. _tbaa_node_semantics:
4821 The TBAA metadata system, referred to as "struct path TBAA" (not to be
4822 confused with ``tbaa.struct``), consists of the following high level
4823 concepts: *Type Descriptors*, further subdivided into scalar type
4824 descriptors and struct type descriptors; and *Access Tags*.
4826 **Type descriptors** describe the type system of the higher level language
4827 being compiled. **Scalar type descriptors** describe types that do not
4828 contain other types. Each scalar type has a parent type, which must also
4829 be a scalar type or the TBAA root. Via this parent relation, scalar types
4830 within a TBAA root form a tree. **Struct type descriptors** denote types
4831 that contain a sequence of other type descriptors, at known offsets. These
4832 contained type descriptors can either be struct type descriptors themselves
4833 or scalar type descriptors.
4835 **Access tags** are metadata nodes attached to load and store instructions.
4836 Access tags use type descriptors to describe the *location* being accessed
4837 in terms of the type system of the higher level language. Access tags are
4838 tuples consisting of a base type, an access type and an offset. The base
4839 type is a scalar type descriptor or a struct type descriptor, the access
4840 type is a scalar type descriptor, and the offset is a constant integer.
4842 The access tag ``(BaseTy, AccessTy, Offset)`` can describe one of two
4845 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type, the tag describes a memory access (load
4846 or store) of a value of type ``AccessTy`` contained in the struct type
4847 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset``.
4849 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type, ``Offset`` must be 0 and ``BaseTy`` and
4850 ``AccessTy`` must be the same; and the access tag describes a scalar
4851 access with scalar type ``AccessTy``.
4853 We first define an ``ImmediateParent`` relation on ``(BaseTy, Offset)``
4856 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, 0)`` is
4857 ``(ParentTy, 0)`` where ``ParentTy`` is the parent of the scalar type as
4858 described in the TBAA metadata. ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)`` is
4859 undefined if ``Offset`` is non-zero.
4861 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)``
4862 is ``(NewTy, NewOffset)`` where ``NewTy`` is the type contained in
4863 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset`` and ``NewOffset`` is ``Offset`` adjusted
4864 to be relative within that inner type.
4866 A memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy1, AccessTy1, Offset1)``
4867 aliases a memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy2, AccessTy2,
4868 Offset2)`` if either ``(BaseTy1, Offset1)`` is reachable from ``(Base2,
4869 Offset2)`` via the ``Parent`` relation or vice versa.
4871 As a concrete example, the type descriptor graph for the following program
4877 float f; // offset 4
4881 float f; // offset 0
4882 double d; // offset 4
4883 struct Inner inner_a; // offset 12
4886 void f(struct Outer* outer, struct Inner* inner, float* f, int* i, char* c) {
4887 outer->f = 0; // tag0: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4888 outer->inner_a.i = 0; // tag1: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 12)
4889 outer->inner_a.f = 0.0; // tag2: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 16)
4890 *f = 0.0; // tag3: (FloatScalarTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4893 is (note that in C and C++, ``char`` can be used to access any arbitrary
4896 .. code-block:: text
4899 CharScalarTy = ("char", Root, 0)
4900 FloatScalarTy = ("float", CharScalarTy, 0)
4901 DoubleScalarTy = ("double", CharScalarTy, 0)
4902 IntScalarTy = ("int", CharScalarTy, 0)
4903 InnerStructTy = {"Inner" (IntScalarTy, 0), (FloatScalarTy, 4)}
4904 OuterStructTy = {"Outer", (FloatScalarTy, 0), (DoubleScalarTy, 4),
4905 (InnerStructTy, 12)}
4908 with (e.g.) ``ImmediateParent(OuterStructTy, 12)`` = ``(InnerStructTy,
4909 0)``, ``ImmediateParent(InnerStructTy, 0)`` = ``(IntScalarTy, 0)``, and
4910 ``ImmediateParent(IntScalarTy, 0)`` = ``(CharScalarTy, 0)``.
4912 .. _tbaa_node_representation:
4917 The root node of a TBAA type hierarchy is an ``MDNode`` with 0 operands or
4918 with exactly one ``MDString`` operand.
4920 Scalar type descriptors are represented as an ``MDNode`` s with two
4921 operands. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting the name of the
4922 struct type. LLVM does not assign meaning to the value of this operand, it
4923 only cares about it being an ``MDString``. The second operand is an
4924 ``MDNode`` which points to the parent for said scalar type descriptor,
4925 which is either another scalar type descriptor or the TBAA root. Scalar
4926 type descriptors can have an optional third argument, but that must be the
4927 constant integer zero.
4929 Struct type descriptors are represented as ``MDNode`` s with an odd number
4930 of operands greater than 1. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting
4931 the name of the struct type. Like in scalar type descriptors the actual
4932 value of this name operand is irrelevant to LLVM. After the name operand,
4933 the struct type descriptors have a sequence of alternating ``MDNode`` and
4934 ``ConstantInt`` operands. With N starting from 1, the 2N - 1 th operand,
4935 an ``MDNode``, denotes a contained field, and the 2N th operand, a
4936 ``ConstantInt``, is the offset of the said contained field. The offsets
4937 must be in non-decreasing order.
4939 Access tags are represented as ``MDNode`` s with either 3 or 4 operands.
4940 The first operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node representing the
4941 base type. The second operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node
4942 representing the access type. The third operand is a ``ConstantInt`` that
4943 states the offset of the access. If a fourth field is present, it must be
4944 a ``ConstantInt`` valued at 0 or 1. If it is 1 then the access tag states
4945 that the location being accessed is "constant" (meaning
4946 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
4947 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). The TBAA root of
4948 the access type and the base type of an access tag must be the same, and
4949 that is the TBAA root of the access tag.
4951 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4952 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4954 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4955 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4956 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4957 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4958 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4961 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4962 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4964 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4965 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4966 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4967 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4970 .. code-block:: llvm
4972 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
4974 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4975 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4976 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4978 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
4979 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4980 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4982 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
4983 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4985 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4986 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4987 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4988 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4989 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
4990 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
4993 When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
4994 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
4995 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
4996 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4999 Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
5000 domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
5001 used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
5002 turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
5003 function is inlined.
5005 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
5006 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
5007 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
5008 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
5009 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
5011 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
5012 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
5013 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
5014 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
5015 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
5016 optionally be provided as a third list entry.
5020 .. code-block:: llvm
5022 ; Two scope domains:
5026 ; Some scopes in these domains:
5032 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
5036 ; These two instructions don't alias:
5037 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5038 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
5040 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
5041 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
5042 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5043 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
5045 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
5046 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
5047 ; !alias.scope list):
5048 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
5049 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
5051 '``fpmath``' Metadata
5052 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5054 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating-point
5055 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
5056 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
5057 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
5058 it. ULP is defined as follows:
5060 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
5061 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
5062 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
5063 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
5064 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
5066 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
5067 representing the maximum relative error, for example:
5069 .. code-block:: llvm
5071 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
5075 '``range``' Metadata
5076 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5078 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
5079 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
5080 returned by the called function at this call site is in. If the loaded or
5081 returned value is not in the specified range, the behavior is undefined. The
5082 ranges are represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or
5083 the value returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each
5084 consecutive pair. Each pair has the following properties:
5086 - The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
5087 - The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
5088 - Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
5089 - The range is allowed to wrap.
5090 - The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
5093 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
5094 they must be non-contiguous.
5098 .. code-block:: llvm
5100 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
5101 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
5102 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
5103 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
5104 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
5106 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
5107 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
5108 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
5109 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
5111 '``absolute_symbol``' Metadata
5112 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5114 ``absolute_symbol`` metadata may be attached to a global variable
5115 declaration. It marks the declaration as a reference to an absolute symbol,
5116 which causes the backend to use absolute relocations for the symbol even
5117 in position independent code, and expresses the possible ranges that the
5118 global variable's *address* (not its value) is in, in the same format as
5119 ``range`` metadata, with the extension that the pair ``all-ones,all-ones``
5120 may be used to represent the full set.
5122 Example (assuming 64-bit pointers):
5124 .. code-block:: llvm
5126 @a = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !0 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,256)
5127 @b = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !1 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,2^64)
5130 !0 = !{ i64 0, i64 256 }
5131 !1 = !{ i64 -1, i64 -1 }
5133 '``callees``' Metadata
5134 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5136 ``callees`` metadata may be attached to indirect call sites. If ``callees``
5137 metadata is attached to a call site, and any callee is not among the set of
5138 functions provided by the metadata, the behavior is undefined. The intent of
5139 this metadata is to facilitate optimizations such as indirect-call promotion.
5140 For example, in the code below, the call instruction may only target the
5141 ``add`` or ``sub`` functions:
5143 .. code-block:: llvm
5145 %result = call i64 %binop(i64 %x, i64 %y), !callees !0
5148 !0 = !{i64 (i64, i64)* @add, i64 (i64, i64)* @sub}
5150 '``callback``' Metadata
5151 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5153 ``callback`` metadata may be attached to a function declaration, or definition.
5154 (Call sites are excluded only due to the lack of a use case.) For ease of
5155 exposition, we'll refer to the function annotated w/ metadata as a broker
5156 function. The metadata describes how the arguments of a call to the broker are
5157 in turn passed to the callback function specified by the metadata. Thus, the
5158 ``callback`` metadata provides a partial description of a call site inside the
5159 broker function with regards to the arguments of a call to the broker. The only
5160 semantic restriction on the broker function itself is that it is not allowed to
5161 inspect or modify arguments referenced in the ``callback`` metadata as
5162 pass-through to the callback function.
5164 The broker is not required to actually invoke the callback function at runtime.
5165 However, the assumptions about not inspecting or modifying arguments that would
5166 be passed to the specified callback function still hold, even if the callback
5167 function is not dynamically invoked. The broker is allowed to invoke the
5168 callback function more than once per invocation of the broker. The broker is
5169 also allowed to invoke (directly or indirectly) the function passed as a
5170 callback through another use. Finally, the broker is also allowed to relay the
5171 callback callee invocation to a different thread.
5173 The metadata is structured as follows: At the outer level, ``callback``
5174 metadata is a list of ``callback`` encodings. Each encoding starts with a
5175 constant ``i64`` which describes the argument position of the callback function
5176 in the call to the broker. The following elements, except the last, describe
5177 what arguments are passed to the callback function. Each element is again an
5178 ``i64`` constant identifying the argument of the broker that is passed through,
5179 or ``i64 -1`` to indicate an unknown or inspected argument. The order in which
5180 they are listed has to be the same in which they are passed to the callback
5181 callee. The last element of the encoding is a boolean which specifies how
5182 variadic arguments of the broker are handled. If it is true, all variadic
5183 arguments of the broker are passed through to the callback function *after* the
5184 arguments encoded explicitly before.
5186 In the code below, the ``pthread_create`` function is marked as a broker
5187 through the ``!callback !1`` metadata. In the example, there is only one
5188 callback encoding, namely ``!2``, associated with the broker. This encoding
5189 identifies the callback function as the second argument of the broker (``i64
5190 2``) and the sole argument of the callback function as the third one of the
5191 broker function (``i64 3``).
5193 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5194 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5195 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5197 .. code-block:: text
5199 declare !callback !1 dso_local i32 @pthread_create(i64*, %union.pthread_attr_t*, i8* (i8*)*, i8*)
5202 !2 = !{i64 2, i64 3, i1 false}
5205 Another example is shown below. The callback callee is the second argument of
5206 the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` function (``i64 2``). The callee is given two unknown
5207 values (each identified by a ``i64 -1``) and afterwards all
5208 variadic arguments that are passed to the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` call (due to the
5211 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5212 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5213 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5215 .. code-block:: text
5217 declare !callback !0 dso_local void @__kmpc_fork_call(%struct.ident_t*, i32, void (i32*, i32*, ...)*, ...)
5220 !1 = !{i64 2, i64 -1, i64 -1, i1 true}
5224 '``unpredictable``' Metadata
5225 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5227 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
5228 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
5229 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
5230 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
5231 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
5232 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
5239 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
5240 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
5241 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
5242 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
5243 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
5245 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
5246 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
5247 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
5248 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
5249 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
5252 .. code-block:: llvm
5257 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
5258 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
5259 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
5260 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
5262 .. code-block:: llvm
5264 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
5267 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5269 '``llvm.loop.disable_nonforced``'
5270 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5272 This metadata disables all optional loop transformations unless
5273 explicitly instructed using other transformation metdata such as
5274 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. That is, no heuristic will try to determine
5275 whether a transformation is profitable. The purpose is to avoid that the
5276 loop is transformed to a different loop before an explicitly requested
5277 (forced) transformation is applied. For instance, loop fusion can make
5278 other transformations impossible. Mandatory loop canonicalizations such
5279 as loop rotation are still applied.
5281 It is recommended to use this metadata in addition to any llvm.loop.*
5282 transformation directive. Also, any loop should have at most one
5283 directive applied to it (and a sequence of transformations built using
5284 followup-attributes). Otherwise, which transformation will be applied
5285 depends on implementation details such as the pass pipeline order.
5287 See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5289 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
5290 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5292 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
5293 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
5294 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
5295 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
5296 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
5297 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
5298 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata
5299 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
5300 in determining the safety of these transformations.
5302 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
5303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5305 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
5306 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
5307 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
5310 .. code-block:: llvm
5312 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
5314 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
5315 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
5316 then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
5318 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
5319 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5321 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
5322 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
5323 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
5324 0 disables vectorization:
5326 .. code-block:: llvm
5328 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
5329 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
5331 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
5332 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5334 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
5335 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
5336 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
5338 .. code-block:: llvm
5340 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
5342 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
5343 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
5344 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
5345 determined automatically.
5347 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_vectorized``' Metadata
5348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5350 This metadata defines which loop attributes the vectorized loop will
5351 have. See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5353 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_epilogue``' Metadata
5354 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5356 This metadata defines which loop attributes the epilogue will have. The
5357 epilogue is not vectorized and is executed when either the vectorized
5358 loop is not known to preserve semantics (because e.g., it processes two
5359 arrays that are found to alias by a runtime check) or for the last
5360 iterations that do not fill a complete set of vector lanes. See
5361 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5363 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_all``' Metadata
5364 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5366 Attributes in the metadata will be added to both the vectorized and
5368 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5370 '``llvm.loop.unroll``'
5371 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5373 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
5374 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
5375 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5376 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
5377 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
5378 optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
5380 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
5381 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5383 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
5384 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
5385 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
5388 .. code-block:: llvm
5390 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5392 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5393 will be partially unrolled.
5395 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
5396 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5398 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
5399 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
5401 .. code-block:: llvm
5403 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
5405 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
5406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5408 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
5409 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
5411 .. code-block:: llvm
5413 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
5415 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
5416 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5418 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
5419 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
5420 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
5421 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
5423 .. code-block:: llvm
5425 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
5427 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
5428 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5430 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
5431 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
5434 .. code-block:: llvm
5436 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
5438 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup``' Metadata
5439 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5441 This metadata defines which loop attributes the unrolled loop will have.
5442 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5444 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup_remainder``' Metadata
5445 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5447 This metadata defines which loop attributes the remainder loop after
5448 partial/runtime unrolling will have. See
5449 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5451 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam``'
5452 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5454 This metadata is treated very similarly to the ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata
5455 above, but affect the unroll and jam pass. In addition any loop with
5456 ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata but no ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam`` metadata will
5457 disable unroll and jam (so ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata will be left to the
5458 unroller, plus ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable`` metadata will disable unroll and jam
5461 The metadata for unroll and jam otherwise is the same as for ``unroll``.
5462 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``, ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable`` and
5463 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` do the same as for unroll.
5464 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.full`` is not supported. Again these are only hints
5465 and the normal safety checks will still be performed.
5467 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count``' Metadata
5468 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5470 This metadata suggests an unroll and jam factor to use, similarly to
5471 ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``. The first operand is the string
5472 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` and the second operand is a positive integer
5473 specifying the unroll factor. For example:
5475 .. code-block:: llvm
5477 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count", i32 4}
5479 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5480 will be partially unroll and jammed.
5482 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``' Metadata
5483 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5485 This metadata disables loop unroll and jamming. The metadata has a single
5486 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``. For example:
5488 .. code-block:: llvm
5490 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable"}
5492 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``' Metadata
5493 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5495 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unroll and jammed if the
5496 trip count is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is
5497 not known at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the
5498 string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``. For example:
5500 .. code-block:: llvm
5502 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable"}
5504 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_outer``' Metadata
5505 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5507 This metadata defines which loop attributes the outer unrolled loop will
5508 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5511 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_inner``' Metadata
5512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5514 This metadata defines which loop attributes the inner jammed loop will
5515 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5518 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_outer``' Metadata
5519 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5521 This metadata defines which attributes the epilogue of the outer loop
5522 will have. This loop is usually unrolled, meaning there is no such
5523 loop. This attribute will be ignored in this case. See
5524 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5526 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_inner``' Metadata
5527 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5529 This metadata defines which attributes the inner loop of the epilogue
5530 will have. The outer epilogue will usually be unrolled, meaning there
5531 can be multiple inner remainder loops. See
5532 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5534 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_all``' Metadata
5535 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5537 Attributes specified in the metadata is added to all
5538 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.*`` loops. See
5539 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5541 '``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
5542 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5544 This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
5545 of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
5546 which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
5548 .. code-block:: llvm
5550 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
5552 '``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
5553 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5555 Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
5556 this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
5557 memory dependencies. The transformation will attempt to isolate the unsafe
5558 dependencies into their own loop.
5560 This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
5561 loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
5562 second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
5563 enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
5565 .. code-block:: llvm
5567 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
5568 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
5570 This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5571 identification metadata.
5573 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_coincident``' Metadata
5574 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5576 This metadata defines which attributes extracted loops with no cyclic
5577 dependencies will have (i.e. can be vectorized). See
5578 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5580 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_sequential``' Metadata
5581 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5583 This metadata defines which attributes the isolated loops with unsafe
5584 memory dependencies will have. See
5585 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5587 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_fallback``' Metadata
5588 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5590 If loop versioning is necessary, this metadata defined the attributes
5591 the non-distributed fallback version will have. See
5592 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5594 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_all``' Metadata
5595 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5597 Thes attributes in this metdata is added to all followup loops of the
5598 loop distribution pass. See
5599 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5601 '``llvm.access.group``' Metadata
5602 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5604 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata can be attached to any instruction that
5605 potentially accesses memory. It can point to a single distinct metadata
5606 node, which we call access group. This node represents all memory access
5607 instructions referring to it via ``llvm.access.group``. When an
5608 instruction belongs to multiple access groups, it can also point to a
5609 list of accesses groups, illustrated by the following example.
5611 .. code-block:: llvm
5613 %val = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !0
5619 It is illegal for the list node to be empty since it might be confused
5620 with an access group.
5622 The access group metadata node must be 'distinct' to avoid collapsing
5623 multiple access groups by content. A access group metadata node must
5624 always be empty which can be used to distinguish an access group
5625 metadata node from a list of access groups. Being empty avoids the
5626 situation that the content must be updated which, because metadata is
5627 immutable by design, would required finding and updating all references
5628 to the access group node.
5630 The access group can be used to refer to a memory access instruction
5631 without pointing to it directly (which is not possible in global
5632 metadata). Currently, the only metadata making use of it is
5633 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``.
5635 '``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``' Metadata
5636 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5638 The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata refers to one or more
5639 access group metadata nodes (see ``llvm.access.group``). It denotes that
5640 no loop-carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions
5641 in the loop with this metadata.
5643 Let ``m1`` and ``m2`` be two instructions that both have the
5644 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata to the access group ``g1``, respectively
5645 ``g2`` (which might be identical). If a loop contains both access groups
5646 in its ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata, then the compiler can
5647 assume that there is no dependency between ``m1`` and ``m2`` carried by
5648 this loop. Instructions that belong to multiple access groups are
5649 considered having this property if at least one of the access groups
5650 matches the ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` list.
5652 If all memory-accessing instructions in a loop have
5653 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
5654 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a
5657 Note that if not all memory access instructions belong to an access
5658 group referred to by ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``, then the loop must
5659 not be considered trivially parallel. Additional
5660 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
5661 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
5662 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
5663 insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
5665 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
5666 both ``llvm.access.group`` and ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``
5669 .. code-block:: llvm
5673 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !1
5675 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !1
5677 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
5681 !0 = distinct !{!0, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !1}}
5684 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops:
5686 .. code-block:: llvm
5690 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.access.group !4
5692 br label %inner.for.body
5696 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !3
5698 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.access.group !3
5700 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
5704 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.access.group !4
5706 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
5708 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
5710 !1 = distinct !{!1, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3}} ; metadata for the inner loop
5711 !2 = distinct !{!2, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3, !4}} ; metadata for the outer loop
5712 !3 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the inner loop (which are implicitly contained in outer loop as well)
5713 !4 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the outer, but not the inner loop
5715 '``irr_loop``' Metadata
5716 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5718 ``irr_loop`` metadata may be attached to the terminator instruction of a basic
5719 block that's an irreducible loop header (note that an irreducible loop has more
5720 than once header basic blocks.) If ``irr_loop`` metadata is attached to the
5721 terminator instruction of a basic block that is not really an irreducible loop
5722 header, the behavior is undefined. The intent of this metadata is to improve the
5723 accuracy of the block frequency propagation. For example, in the code below, the
5724 block ``header0`` may have a loop header weight (relative to the other headers of
5725 the irreducible loop) of 100:
5727 .. code-block:: llvm
5731 br i1 %cmp, label %t1, label %t2, !irr_loop !0
5734 !0 = !{"loop_header_weight", i64 100}
5736 Irreducible loop header weights are typically based on profile data.
5738 '``invariant.group``' Metadata
5739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5741 The experimental ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to
5742 ``load``/``store`` instructions referencing a single metadata with no entries.
5743 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
5744 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
5745 can be assumed to load or store the same
5746 value (but see the ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` intrinsic which affects
5747 when two pointers are considered the same). Pointers returned by bitcast or
5748 getelementptr with only zero indices are considered the same.
5752 .. code-block:: llvm
5754 @unknownPtr = external global i8
5757 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
5758 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5760 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
5761 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5763 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
5764 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
5766 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
5767 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
5769 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5770 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8* %ptr)
5771 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through launder.invariant.group to get value of %ptr
5774 declare void @foo(i8*)
5775 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
5776 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8*)
5780 The invariant.group metadata must be dropped when replacing one pointer by
5781 another based on aliasing information. This is because invariant.group is tied
5782 to the SSA value of the pointer operand.
5784 .. code-block:: llvm
5786 %v = load i8, i8* %x, !invariant.group !0
5787 ; if %x mustalias %y then we can replace the above instruction with
5788 %v = load i8, i8* %y
5790 Note that this is an experimental feature, which means that its semantics might
5791 change in the future.
5796 See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
5798 '``associated``' Metadata
5799 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5801 The ``associated`` metadata may be attached to a global object
5802 declaration with a single argument that references another global object.
5804 This metadata prevents discarding of the global object in linker GC
5805 unless the referenced object is also discarded. The linker support for
5806 this feature is spotty. For best compatibility, globals carrying this
5809 - Be in a comdat with the referenced global.
5810 - Be in @llvm.compiler.used.
5811 - Have an explicit section with a name which is a valid C identifier.
5813 It does not have any effect on non-ELF targets.
5817 .. code-block:: text
5820 @a = global i32 1, comdat $a
5821 @b = internal global i32 2, comdat $a, section "abc", !associated !0
5828 The ``prof`` metadata is used to record profile data in the IR.
5829 The first operand of the metadata node indicates the profile metadata
5830 type. There are currently 3 types:
5831 :ref:`branch_weights<prof_node_branch_weights>`,
5832 :ref:`function_entry_count<prof_node_function_entry_count>`, and
5833 :ref:`VP<prof_node_VP>`.
5835 .. _prof_node_branch_weights:
5840 Branch weight metadata attached to a branch, select, switch or call instruction
5841 represents the likeliness of the associated branch being taken.
5842 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5844 .. _prof_node_function_entry_count:
5846 function_entry_count
5847 """"""""""""""""""""
5849 Function entry count metadata can be attached to function definitions
5850 to record the number of times the function is called. Used with BFI
5851 information, it is also used to derive the basic block profile count.
5852 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5859 VP (value profile) metadata can be attached to instructions that have
5860 value profile information. Currently this is indirect calls (where it
5861 records the hottest callees) and calls to memory intrinsics such as memcpy,
5862 memmove, and memset (where it records the hottest byte lengths).
5864 Each VP metadata node contains "VP" string, then a uint32_t value for the value
5865 profiling kind, a uint64_t value for the total number of times the instruction
5866 is executed, followed by uint64_t value and execution count pairs.
5867 The value profiling kind is 0 for indirect call targets and 1 for memory
5868 operations. For indirect call targets, each profile value is a hash
5869 of the callee function name, and for memory operations each value is the
5872 Note that the value counts do not need to add up to the total count
5873 listed in the third operand (in practice only the top hottest values
5874 are tracked and reported).
5876 Indirect call example:
5878 .. code-block:: llvm
5880 call void %f(), !prof !1
5881 !1 = !{!"VP", i32 0, i64 1600, i64 7651369219802541373, i64 1030, i64 -4377547752858689819, i64 410}
5883 Note that the VP type is 0 (the second operand), which indicates this is
5884 an indirect call value profile data. The third operand indicates that the
5885 indirect call executed 1600 times. The 4th and 6th operands give the
5886 hashes of the 2 hottest target functions' names (this is the same hash used
5887 to represent function names in the profile database), and the 5th and 7th
5888 operands give the execution count that each of the respective prior target
5889 functions was called.
5891 Module Flags Metadata
5892 =====================
5894 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
5895 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
5896 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
5897 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
5898 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
5901 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
5902 Each triplet has the following form:
5904 - The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
5905 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
5906 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
5908 - The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
5909 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
5910 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
5911 - The third element is the value of the flag.
5913 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
5914 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
5915 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
5916 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
5917 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
5918 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
5920 The following behaviors are supported:
5931 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
5932 is that of the operands.
5936 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
5937 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
5941 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
5942 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
5943 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
5944 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
5945 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
5946 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
5947 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
5951 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
5952 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
5953 differ, an error will be emitted.
5957 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
5961 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
5962 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
5963 during the append operation.
5967 Takes the max of the two values, which are required to be integers.
5969 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
5970 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
5971 value) or **Override**.
5973 An example of module flags:
5975 .. code-block:: llvm
5977 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
5978 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
5979 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
5980 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
5985 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
5987 - Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
5988 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
5989 values are not equal.
5991 - Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
5992 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
5995 - Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
5996 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
5997 warning if their values are not equal.
5999 - Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
6005 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
6006 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
6009 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
6010 ----------------------------------------------------
6012 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
6013 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
6014 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
6015 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
6016 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
6017 be merged rather than appended together.
6019 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
6020 following key-value pairs:
6029 * - ``Objective-C Version``
6030 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
6032 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
6033 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
6036 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
6037 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
6038 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
6039 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
6040 Objective-C ABI version 2.
6042 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
6043 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
6044 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
6045 collection supported.
6047 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
6048 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
6049 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
6050 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
6052 Some important flag interactions:
6054 - If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
6055 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
6056 2, then the resulting module has the
6057 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
6058 - A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
6059 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
6061 C type width Module Flags Metadata
6062 ----------------------------------
6064 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
6065 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
6066 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
6067 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
6070 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
6071 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
6081 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
6082 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
6085 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
6086 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
6087 represent all of its values.
6089 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
6090 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
6091 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
6093 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
6094 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
6095 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
6097 Automatic Linker Flags Named Metadata
6098 =====================================
6100 Some targets support embedding of flags to the linker inside individual object
6101 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
6102 allow source files to contain linker command line options, and have these
6103 automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
6105 These flags are encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
6106 ``!llvm.linker.options``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
6107 which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
6108 list of metadata strings defining linker options.
6110 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
6111 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
6115 !1 = !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" }
6116 !llvm.linker.options = !{ !0, !1 }
6118 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
6119 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
6120 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
6121 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
6122 assembly writer or object file emitter.
6124 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
6125 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
6126 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
6128 Dependent Libs Named Metadata
6129 =============================
6131 Some targets support embedding of strings into object files to indicate
6132 a set of libraries to add to the link. Typically this is used in conjunction
6133 with language extensions which allow source files to explicitly declare the
6134 libraries they depend on, and have these automatically be transmitted to the
6135 linker via object files.
6137 The list is encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
6138 ``!llvm.dependent-libraries``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
6139 which should contain a single string operand.
6141 For example, the following metadata section contains two library specfiers::
6143 !0 = !{!"a library specifier"}
6144 !1 = !{!"another library specifier"}
6145 !llvm.dependent-libraries = !{ !0, !1 }
6147 Each library specifier will be handled independently by the consuming linker.
6148 The effect of the library specifiers are defined by the consuming linker.
6155 Compiling with `ThinLTO <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/ThinLTO.html>`_
6156 causes the building of a compact summary of the module that is emitted into
6157 the bitcode. The summary is emitted into the LLVM assembly and identified
6158 in syntax by a caret ('``^``').
6160 The summary is parsed into a bitcode output, along with the Module
6161 IR, via the "``llvm-as``" tool. Tools that parse the Module IR for the purposes
6162 of optimization (e.g. "``clang -x ir``" and "``opt``"), will ignore the
6163 summary entries (just as they currently ignore summary entries in a bitcode
6166 Eventually, the summary will be parsed into a ModuleSummaryIndex object under
6167 the same conditions where summary index is currently built from bitcode.
6168 Specifically, tools that test the Thin Link portion of a ThinLTO compile
6169 (i.e. llvm-lto and llvm-lto2), or when parsing a combined index
6170 for a distributed ThinLTO backend via clang's "``-fthinlto-index=<>``" flag
6171 (this part is not yet implemented, use llvm-as to create a bitcode object
6172 before feeding into thin link tools for now).
6174 There are currently 3 types of summary entries in the LLVM assembly:
6175 :ref:`module paths<module_path_summary>`,
6176 :ref:`global values<gv_summary>`, and
6177 :ref:`type identifiers<typeid_summary>`.
6179 .. _module_path_summary:
6181 Module Path Summary Entry
6182 -------------------------
6184 Each module path summary entry lists a module containing global values included
6185 in the summary. For a single IR module there will be one such entry, but
6186 in a combined summary index produced during the thin link, there will be
6187 one module path entry per linked module with summary.
6191 .. code-block:: text
6193 ^0 = module: (path: "/path/to/file.o", hash: (2468601609, 1329373163, 1565878005, 638838075, 3148790418))
6195 The ``path`` field is a string path to the bitcode file, and the ``hash``
6196 field is the 160-bit SHA-1 hash of the IR bitcode contents, used for
6197 incremental builds and caching.
6201 Global Value Summary Entry
6202 --------------------------
6204 Each global value summary entry corresponds to a global value defined or
6205 referenced by a summarized module.
6209 .. code-block:: text
6211 ^4 = gv: (name: "f"[, summaries: (Summary)[, (Summary)]*]?) ; guid = 14740650423002898831
6213 For declarations, there will not be a summary list. For definitions, a
6214 global value will contain a list of summaries, one per module containing
6215 a definition. There can be multiple entries in a combined summary index
6216 for symbols with weak linkage.
6218 Each ``Summary`` format will depend on whether the global value is a
6219 :ref:`function<function_summary>`, :ref:`variable<variable_summary>`, or
6220 :ref:`alias<alias_summary>`.
6222 .. _function_summary:
6227 If the global value is a function, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6229 .. code-block:: text
6231 function: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), insts: 2[, FuncFlags]?[, Calls]?[, TypeIdInfo]?[, Refs]?
6233 The ``module`` field includes the summary entry id for the module containing
6234 this definition, and the ``flags`` field contains information such as
6235 the linkage type, a flag indicating whether it is legal to import the
6236 definition, whether it is globally live and whether the linker resolved it
6237 to a local definition (the latter two are populated during the thin link).
6238 The ``insts`` field contains the number of IR instructions in the function.
6239 Finally, there are several optional fields: :ref:`FuncFlags<funcflags_summary>`,
6240 :ref:`Calls<calls_summary>`, :ref:`TypeIdInfo<typeidinfo_summary>`,
6241 :ref:`Refs<refs_summary>`.
6243 .. _variable_summary:
6245 Global Variable Summary
6246 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6248 If the global value is a variable, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6250 .. code-block:: text
6252 variable: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0)[, Refs]?
6254 The variable entry contains a subset of the fields in a
6255 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`, see the descriptions there.
6262 If the global value is an alias, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6264 .. code-block:: text
6266 alias: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), aliasee: ^2)
6268 The ``module`` and ``flags`` fields are as described for a
6269 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`. The ``aliasee`` field
6270 contains a reference to the global value summary entry of the aliasee.
6272 .. _funcflags_summary:
6277 The optional ``FuncFlags`` field looks like:
6279 .. code-block:: text
6281 funcFlags: (readNone: 0, readOnly: 0, noRecurse: 0, returnDoesNotAlias: 0)
6283 If unspecified, flags are assumed to hold the conservative ``false`` value of
6291 The optional ``Calls`` field looks like:
6293 .. code-block:: text
6295 calls: ((Callee)[, (Callee)]*)
6297 where each ``Callee`` looks like:
6299 .. code-block:: text
6301 callee: ^1[, hotness: None]?[, relbf: 0]?
6303 The ``callee`` refers to the summary entry id of the callee. At most one
6304 of ``hotness`` (which can take the values ``Unknown``, ``Cold``, ``None``,
6305 ``Hot``, and ``Critical``), and ``relbf`` (which holds the integer
6306 branch frequency relative to the entry frequency, scaled down by 2^8)
6307 may be specified. The defaults are ``Unknown`` and ``0``, respectively.
6314 The optional ``Refs`` field looks like:
6316 .. code-block:: text
6318 refs: ((Ref)[, (Ref)]*)
6320 where each ``Ref`` contains a reference to the summary id of the referenced
6321 value (e.g. ``^1``).
6323 .. _typeidinfo_summary:
6328 The optional ``TypeIdInfo`` field, used for
6329 `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6332 .. code-block:: text
6334 typeIdInfo: [(TypeTests)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadVCalls)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls)]?
6336 These optional fields have the following forms:
6341 .. code-block:: text
6343 typeTests: (TypeIdRef[, TypeIdRef]*)
6345 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6346 by summary id or ``GUID``.
6348 TypeTestAssumeVCalls
6349 """"""""""""""""""""
6351 .. code-block:: text
6353 typeTestAssumeVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6355 Where each VFuncId has the format:
6357 .. code-block:: text
6359 vFuncId: (TypeIdRef, offset: 16)
6361 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6362 by summary id or ``GUID`` preceeded by a ``guid:`` tag.
6364 TypeCheckedLoadVCalls
6365 """""""""""""""""""""
6367 .. code-block:: text
6369 typeCheckedLoadVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6371 Where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``.
6373 TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls
6374 """""""""""""""""""""""""
6376 .. code-block:: text
6378 typeTestAssumeConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6380 Where each ConstVCall has the format:
6382 .. code-block:: text
6384 (VFuncId, args: (Arg[, Arg]*))
6386 and where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``,
6387 and each Arg is an integer argument number.
6389 TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls
6390 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
6392 .. code-block:: text
6394 typeCheckedLoadConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6396 Where each ConstVCall has the format described for
6397 ``TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls``.
6401 Type ID Summary Entry
6402 ---------------------
6404 Each type id summary entry corresponds to a type identifier resolution
6405 which is generated during the LTO link portion of the compile when building
6406 with `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6407 so these are only present in a combined summary index.
6411 .. code-block:: text
6413 ^4 = typeid: (name: "_ZTS1A", summary: (typeTestRes: (kind: allOnes, sizeM1BitWidth: 7[, alignLog2: 0]?[, sizeM1: 0]?[, bitMask: 0]?[, inlineBits: 0]?)[, WpdResolutions]?)) ; guid = 7004155349499253778
6415 The ``typeTestRes`` gives the type test resolution ``kind`` (which may
6416 be ``unsat``, ``byteArray``, ``inline``, ``single``, or ``allOnes``), and
6417 the ``size-1`` bit width. It is followed by optional flags, which default to 0,
6418 and an optional WpdResolutions (whole program devirtualization resolution)
6419 field that looks like:
6421 .. code-block:: text
6423 wpdResolutions: ((offset: 0, WpdRes)[, (offset: 1, WpdRes)]*
6425 where each entry is a mapping from the given byte offset to the whole-program
6426 devirtualization resolution WpdRes, that has one of the following formats:
6428 .. code-block:: text
6430 wpdRes: (kind: branchFunnel)
6431 wpdRes: (kind: singleImpl, singleImplName: "_ZN1A1nEi")
6432 wpdRes: (kind: indir)
6434 Additionally, each wpdRes has an optional ``resByArg`` field, which
6435 describes the resolutions for calls with all constant integer arguments:
6437 .. code-block:: text
6439 resByArg: (ResByArg[, ResByArg]*)
6443 .. code-block:: text
6445 args: (Arg[, Arg]*), byArg: (kind: UniformRetVal[, info: 0][, byte: 0][, bit: 0])
6447 Where the ``kind`` can be ``Indir``, ``UniformRetVal``, ``UniqueRetVal``
6448 or ``VirtualConstProp``. The ``info`` field is only used if the kind
6449 is ``UniformRetVal`` (indicates the uniform return value), or
6450 ``UniqueRetVal`` (holds the return value associated with the unique vtable
6451 (0 or 1)). The ``byte`` and ``bit`` fields are only used if the target does
6452 not support the use of absolute symbols to store constants.
6454 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
6456 Intrinsic Global Variables
6457 ==========================
6459 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
6460 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
6461 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
6462 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
6463 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
6467 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
6468 -----------------------------------
6470 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
6471 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
6472 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
6473 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
6476 .. code-block:: llvm
6481 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
6483 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
6484 ], section "llvm.metadata"
6486 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
6487 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
6488 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
6489 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
6490 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
6491 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
6492 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
6494 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
6495 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
6496 molesting the symbol.
6498 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
6500 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
6501 --------------------------------------------
6503 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
6504 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
6505 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
6506 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
6509 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
6510 and should not be exposed to source languages.
6512 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
6514 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
6515 -------------------------------------------
6517 .. code-block:: llvm
6519 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6520 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
6522 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
6523 functions, priorities, and an associated global or function.
6524 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
6525 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
6526 functions with the same priority is not defined.
6528 If the third field is non-null, and points to a global variable
6529 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
6530 data from the current module is not discarded.
6532 .. _llvmglobaldtors:
6534 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
6535 -------------------------------------------
6537 .. code-block:: llvm
6539 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6540 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
6542 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
6543 functions, priorities, and an associated global or function.
6544 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
6545 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
6546 order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
6548 If the third field is non-null, and points to a global variable
6549 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
6550 data from the current module is not discarded.
6552 Instruction Reference
6553 =====================
6555 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
6556 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
6557 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
6558 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
6559 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
6563 Terminator Instructions
6564 -----------------------
6566 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
6567 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
6568 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
6569 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
6570 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
6571 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
6573 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
6574 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
6575 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
6576 ':ref:`callbr <i_callbr>`'
6577 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
6578 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
6579 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
6580 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
6584 '``ret``' Instruction
6585 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6592 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
6593 ret void ; Return from void function
6598 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
6599 a value) from a function back to the caller.
6601 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
6602 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
6608 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
6609 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
6610 class <t_firstclass>`' type.
6612 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it has a non-void
6613 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
6614 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
6615 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
6621 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
6622 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
6623 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6624 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
6625 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6626 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
6627 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
6633 .. code-block:: llvm
6635 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
6636 ret void ; Return from a void function
6637 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
6641 '``br``' Instruction
6642 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6649 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
6650 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
6655 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
6656 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
6657 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
6658 unconditional branch.
6663 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
6664 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
6665 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
6670 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
6671 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
6672 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
6673 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
6678 .. code-block:: llvm
6681 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
6682 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
6690 '``switch``' Instruction
6691 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6698 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
6703 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
6704 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
6705 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
6711 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
6712 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
6713 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
6714 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
6719 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
6720 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
6721 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
6722 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
6723 to the default destination.
6728 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
6729 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
6730 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
6731 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
6736 .. code-block:: llvm
6738 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
6739 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
6740 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
6742 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
6743 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
6745 ; Implement a jump table:
6746 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
6748 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
6752 '``indirectbr``' Instruction
6753 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6760 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
6765 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
6766 label within the current function, whose address is specified by
6767 "``address``". Address must be derived from a
6768 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
6773 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
6774 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
6775 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
6776 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
6778 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
6779 accurate understanding of the CFG.
6784 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
6785 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
6786 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
6787 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
6792 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
6797 .. code-block:: llvm
6799 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
6803 '``invoke``' Instruction
6804 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6811 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
6812 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
6817 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6818 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6819 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
6820 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
6821 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
6822 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
6823 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
6824 nearest "exception" label.
6826 The '``exception``' label is a `landing
6827 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
6828 '``exception``' label is required to have the
6829 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
6830 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
6831 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
6832 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
6833 instruction, so that the important information contained within the
6834 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
6839 This instruction requires several arguments:
6841 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6842 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6843 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6844 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6845 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6847 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
6848 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
6849 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
6850 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6851 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6853 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
6854 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6855 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6856 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6857 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
6858 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6860 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6861 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6862 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6863 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6864 extra arguments can be specified.
6865 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6866 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6867 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
6868 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
6870 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
6871 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
6876 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6877 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6878 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
6879 library to unwind the stack.
6881 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
6882 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
6883 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
6884 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
6886 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
6887 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
6888 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
6889 return value is available.
6894 .. code-block:: llvm
6896 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
6897 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6898 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
6899 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6903 '``callbr``' Instruction
6904 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6911 <result> = callbr [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
6912 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> or jump [other labels]
6917 The '``callbr``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6918 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6919 '``normal``' label or one of the '``other``' labels.
6921 This instruction should only be used to implement the "goto" feature of gcc
6922 style inline assembly. Any other usage is an error in the IR verifier.
6927 This instruction requires several arguments:
6929 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6930 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6931 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6932 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6933 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6935 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
6936 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
6937 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
6938 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6939 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6941 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
6942 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6943 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6944 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6945 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
6946 indirect ``callbr``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6948 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6949 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6950 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6951 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6952 extra arguments can be specified.
6953 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6954 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6955 #. '``other labels``': the labels reached when a callee transfers control
6956 to a location other than the normal '``normal label``'
6957 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
6958 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
6963 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6964 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6965 establishes an association with additional labels to define where control
6966 flow goes after the call.
6968 The only use of this today is to implement the "goto" feature of gcc inline
6969 assembly where additional labels can be provided as locations for the inline
6970 assembly to jump to.
6975 .. code-block:: text
6977 callbr void asm "", "r,x"(i32 %x, i8 *blockaddress(@foo, %fail))
6978 to label %normal or jump [label %fail]
6982 '``resume``' Instruction
6983 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6990 resume <type> <value>
6995 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
7001 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
7002 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
7008 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
7009 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
7010 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
7015 .. code-block:: llvm
7017 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
7021 '``catchswitch``' Instruction
7022 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7029 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
7030 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
7035 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
7036 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
7037 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
7042 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
7043 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
7044 this operand may be the token ``none``.
7046 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
7047 either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
7048 must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
7049 the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
7051 The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
7052 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
7057 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
7058 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
7061 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
7062 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
7063 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
7068 .. code-block:: text
7071 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
7073 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
7077 '``catchret``' Instruction
7078 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7085 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
7090 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
7097 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
7098 exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
7099 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
7105 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
7106 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
7107 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
7108 code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
7111 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
7112 If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
7113 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
7114 the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
7119 .. code-block:: text
7121 catchret from %catch label %continue
7125 '``cleanupret``' Instruction
7126 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7133 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
7134 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
7139 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
7140 an optional successor.
7146 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
7147 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
7148 If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
7149 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
7150 the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
7152 The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
7153 which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
7154 ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
7155 be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
7156 `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
7161 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
7162 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
7163 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
7164 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
7169 .. code-block:: text
7171 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
7172 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
7176 '``unreachable``' Instruction
7177 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7189 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
7190 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
7191 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
7192 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
7197 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
7204 Unary operators require a single operand, execute an operation on
7205 it, and produce a single value. The operand might represent multiple
7206 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7207 result value has the same type as its operand.
7211 '``fneg``' Instruction
7212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7219 <result> = fneg [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1> ; yields ty:result
7224 The '``fneg``' instruction returns the negation of its operand.
7229 The argument to the '``fneg``' instruction must be a
7230 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7231 floating-point values.
7236 The value produced is a copy of the operand with its sign bit flipped.
7237 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7238 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7239 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7244 .. code-block:: text
7246 <result> = fneg float %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7253 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
7254 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
7255 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
7256 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7257 result value has the same type as its operands.
7259 There are several different binary operators:
7263 '``add``' Instruction
7264 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7271 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7272 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7273 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7274 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7279 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7284 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
7285 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7286 arguments must have identical types.
7291 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
7293 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7294 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7297 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7298 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7300 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7301 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7302 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7303 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7308 .. code-block:: text
7310 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
7314 '``fadd``' Instruction
7315 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7322 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7327 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7332 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be
7333 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7334 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7339 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two operands.
7340 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7341 environment <floatenv>`.
7342 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7343 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7344 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7349 .. code-block:: text
7351 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
7353 '``sub``' Instruction
7354 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7361 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7362 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7363 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7364 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7369 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7371 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
7372 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
7377 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
7378 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7379 arguments must have identical types.
7384 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
7386 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7387 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7390 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7391 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7393 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7394 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7395 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7396 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7401 .. code-block:: text
7403 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
7404 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
7408 '``fsub``' Instruction
7409 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7416 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7421 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7426 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be
7427 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7428 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7433 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two operands.
7434 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7435 environment <floatenv>`.
7436 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7437 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7438 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7443 .. code-block:: text
7445 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
7446 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7448 '``mul``' Instruction
7449 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7456 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7457 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7458 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7459 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7464 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7469 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
7470 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7471 arguments must have identical types.
7476 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
7478 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
7479 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
7480 bit width of the result.
7482 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
7483 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
7484 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
7485 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
7486 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
7489 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7490 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7491 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7492 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7497 .. code-block:: text
7499 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
7503 '``fmul``' Instruction
7504 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7511 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7516 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7521 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be
7522 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7523 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7528 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two operands.
7529 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7530 environment <floatenv>`.
7531 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7532 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7533 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7538 .. code-block:: text
7540 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
7542 '``udiv``' Instruction
7543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7550 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7551 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7556 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7561 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
7562 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7563 arguments must have identical types.
7568 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
7570 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
7571 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
7573 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7574 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7577 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
7578 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
7579 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
7584 .. code-block:: text
7586 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7588 '``sdiv``' Instruction
7589 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7596 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7597 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7602 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7607 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
7608 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7609 arguments must have identical types.
7614 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
7615 rounded towards zero.
7617 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
7618 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
7620 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7621 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7622 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7623 occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
7625 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
7626 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
7631 .. code-block:: text
7633 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7637 '``fdiv``' Instruction
7638 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7645 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7650 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7655 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be
7656 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7657 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7662 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two operands.
7663 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7664 environment <floatenv>`.
7665 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7666 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7667 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7672 .. code-block:: text
7674 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
7676 '``urem``' Instruction
7677 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7684 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7689 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
7690 division of its two arguments.
7695 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
7696 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7697 arguments must have identical types.
7702 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
7703 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
7706 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
7707 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
7709 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7710 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7716 .. code-block:: text
7718 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7720 '``srem``' Instruction
7721 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7728 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7733 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
7734 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
7735 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
7741 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
7742 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7743 arguments must have identical types.
7748 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
7749 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
7750 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
7751 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
7752 difference, see `The Math
7753 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
7754 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
7756 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
7758 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
7759 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
7761 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7762 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7764 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7765 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
7766 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
7767 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
7768 result of the division and the remainder.)
7773 .. code-block:: text
7775 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7779 '``frem``' Instruction
7780 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7787 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7792 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
7798 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be
7799 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7800 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7805 The value produced is the floating-point remainder of the two operands.
7806 This is the same output as a libm '``fmod``' function, but without any
7807 possibility of setting ``errno``. The remainder has the same sign as the
7809 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7810 environment <floatenv>`.
7811 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7812 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7813 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7818 .. code-block:: text
7820 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
7824 Bitwise Binary Operations
7825 -------------------------
7827 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
7828 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
7829 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
7830 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
7831 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
7833 '``shl``' Instruction
7834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7841 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7842 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7843 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7844 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7849 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
7850 a specified number of bits.
7855 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
7856 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7857 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7862 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
7863 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
7864 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
7865 ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7866 If the arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted
7867 by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7869 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7870 value if it shifts out any non-zero bits.
7871 If the ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7872 value if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the resultant sign bit.
7877 .. code-block:: text
7879 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
7880 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
7881 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
7882 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7883 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
7885 '``lshr``' Instruction
7886 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7893 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7894 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7899 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
7900 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
7905 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
7906 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7907 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7912 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
7913 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
7914 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7915 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7916 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7917 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7919 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
7920 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7925 .. code-block:: text
7927 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7928 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7929 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7930 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
7931 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7932 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
7934 '``ashr``' Instruction
7935 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7942 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7943 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7948 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
7949 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
7955 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
7956 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7957 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7962 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
7963 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
7964 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7965 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7966 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7967 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7969 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
7970 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7975 .. code-block:: text
7977 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7978 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7979 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7980 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
7981 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7982 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
7984 '``and``' Instruction
7985 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7992 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7997 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
8003 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
8004 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8005 arguments must have identical types.
8010 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
8027 .. code-block:: text
8029 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
8030 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
8031 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
8033 '``or``' Instruction
8034 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8041 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8046 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
8052 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
8053 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8054 arguments must have identical types.
8059 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
8078 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
8079 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
8080 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
8082 '``xor``' Instruction
8083 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8090 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
8095 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
8096 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
8097 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
8102 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
8103 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
8104 arguments must have identical types.
8109 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
8126 .. code-block:: text
8128 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
8129 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
8130 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
8131 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
8136 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
8137 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
8138 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
8139 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
8140 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
8141 take full advantage of a specific target.
8143 .. _i_extractelement:
8145 '``extractelement``' Instruction
8146 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8153 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
8154 <result> = extractelement <vscale x n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
8159 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
8160 from a vector at a specified index.
8165 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
8166 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
8167 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
8168 variable of any integer type.
8173 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
8174 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
8175 exceeds the length of ``val`` for a fixed-length vector, the result is a
8176 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`. For a scalable vector, if the value
8177 of ``idx`` exceeds the runtime length of the vector, the result is a
8178 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8183 .. code-block:: text
8185 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
8187 .. _i_insertelement:
8189 '``insertelement``' Instruction
8190 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8197 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
8198 <result> = insertelement <vscale x n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <vscale x n x <ty>>
8203 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
8204 vector at a specified index.
8209 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
8210 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
8211 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
8212 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
8213 index may be a variable of any integer type.
8218 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
8219 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
8220 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val`` for a fixed-length vector,
8221 the result is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`. For a scalable vector,
8222 if the value of ``idx`` exceeds the runtime length of the vector, the result
8223 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8228 .. code-block:: text
8230 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
8232 .. _i_shufflevector:
8234 '``shufflevector``' Instruction
8235 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8242 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
8243 <result> = shufflevector <vscale x n x <ty>> <v1>, <vscale x n x <ty>> v2, <vscale x m x i32> <mask> ; yields <vscale x m x <ty>>
8248 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
8249 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
8250 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
8255 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
8256 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
8257 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
8258 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
8259 same as the element type of the first two operands.
8261 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
8262 constant integer or undef values.
8267 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
8268 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
8269 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
8270 result element gets. If the shuffle mask is undef, the result vector is
8271 undef. If any element of the mask operand is undef, that element of the
8272 result is undef. If the shuffle mask selects an undef element from one
8273 of the input vectors, the resulting element is undef.
8275 For scalable vectors, the only valid mask values at present are
8276 ``zeroinitializer`` and ``undef``, since we cannot write all indices as
8277 literals for a vector with a length unknown at compile time.
8282 .. code-block:: text
8284 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8285 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
8286 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
8287 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
8288 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
8289 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
8290 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8291 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
8293 Aggregate Operations
8294 --------------------
8296 LLVM supports several instructions for working with
8297 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
8301 '``extractvalue``' Instruction
8302 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8309 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
8314 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
8315 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8320 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
8321 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
8322 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
8323 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
8325 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
8327 - Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
8328 omitted and assumed to be zero.
8329 - At least one index must be specified.
8330 - Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
8335 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
8341 .. code-block:: text
8343 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
8347 '``insertvalue``' Instruction
8348 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8355 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
8360 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
8361 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8366 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
8367 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
8368 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
8369 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
8370 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
8371 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
8377 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
8378 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
8379 indices is that of ``elt``.
8384 .. code-block:: llvm
8386 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
8387 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
8388 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
8392 Memory Access and Addressing Operations
8393 ---------------------------------------
8395 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
8396 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
8397 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
8402 '``alloca``' Instruction
8403 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8410 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] [, addrspace(<num>)] ; yields type addrspace(num)*:result
8415 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
8416 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
8417 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
8418 address space for allocas indicated in the datalayout.
8423 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
8424 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
8425 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
8426 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
8427 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
8428 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
8429 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
8430 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
8431 boundary compatible with the type.
8433 '``type``' may be any sized type.
8438 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The allocated memory is
8439 uninitialized, and loading from uninitialized memory produces an undefined
8440 value. The operation itself is undefined if there is insufficient stack
8441 space for the allocation.'``alloca``'d memory is automatically released
8442 when the function returns. The '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used
8443 to represent automatic variables that must have an address available. When
8444 the function returns (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions),
8445 the memory is reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the returned
8446 pointer may not be unique. The order in which memory is allocated (ie.,
8447 which way the stack grows) is not specified.
8452 .. code-block:: llvm
8454 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8455 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
8456 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8457 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8461 '``load``' Instruction
8462 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8469 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
8470 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
8471 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
8472 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
8473 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
8478 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
8483 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
8484 to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
8485 known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
8486 the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
8487 modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
8488 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8490 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8491 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8492 ``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions.
8493 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8494 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8495 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8496 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8497 explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the
8498 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8499 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
8501 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8502 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8503 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8504 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8505 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8506 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
8507 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
8508 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
8509 than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
8510 value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
8511 address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
8512 tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
8513 ``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
8515 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
8516 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8517 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
8518 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
8519 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
8520 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
8521 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
8523 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
8524 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8525 entries. If a load instruction tagged with the ``!invariant.load``
8526 metadata is executed, the optimizer may assume the memory location
8527 referenced by the load contains the same value at all points in the
8528 program where the memory location is known to be dereferenceable;
8529 otherwise, the behavior is undefined.
8531 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8532 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no entries.
8533 See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8535 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
8536 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8537 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
8538 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
8539 never be null. If the value is null at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8540 This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute on parameters and return
8541 values. This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
8543 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8544 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
8545 entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
8546 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
8547 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8548 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
8549 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8550 to loads of a pointer type.
8552 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
8553 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8554 ``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
8555 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
8556 dereferenceable or null.
8557 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8558 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
8559 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8560 to loads of a pointer type.
8562 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8563 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
8564 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
8565 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
8566 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
8567 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
8568 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type. If the returned
8569 value is not appropriately aligned at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8574 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
8575 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
8576 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8577 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
8578 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8579 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
8580 written using a store of the same type.
8585 .. code-block:: llvm
8587 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8588 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8589 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8593 '``store``' Instruction
8594 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8601 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8602 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8607 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
8612 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
8613 address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
8614 pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
8615 operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8616 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
8617 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
8618 <t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
8619 structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
8621 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8622 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8623 ``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions.
8624 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8625 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8626 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8627 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8628 explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if
8629 the alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8630 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
8632 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8633 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8634 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8635 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8636 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8637 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
8638 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
8639 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
8640 value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
8641 alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
8642 address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
8643 races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
8644 data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
8645 even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
8646 function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
8648 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8649 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
8650 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
8651 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
8652 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
8653 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
8656 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
8657 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8662 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
8663 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
8664 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
8665 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8666 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
8667 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8668 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
8669 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
8674 .. code-block:: llvm
8676 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8677 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8678 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8682 '``fence``' Instruction
8683 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8690 fence [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields void
8695 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
8701 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
8702 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
8703 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
8708 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
8709 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
8710 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
8711 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
8712 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
8713 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
8714 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
8715 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
8716 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
8717 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
8718 *happens-before* edge.
8720 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
8721 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
8722 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
8724 A ``fence`` instruction can also take an optional
8725 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8730 .. code-block:: text
8732 fence acquire ; yields void
8733 fence syncscope("singlethread") seq_cst ; yields void
8734 fence syncscope("agent") seq_cst ; yields void
8738 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction
8739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8746 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
8751 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
8752 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
8753 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
8758 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
8759 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
8760 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
8761 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
8762 bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
8763 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
8764 have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
8765 that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
8766 optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
8767 this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8769 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
8770 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
8771 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
8772 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
8773 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
8775 A ``cmpxchg`` instruction can also take an optional
8776 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8778 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
8779 equal to the size in memory of the operand.
8784 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
8785 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the values are equal, '``<new>``' is
8786 written to the location. The original value at the location is returned,
8787 together with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
8789 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
8790 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
8793 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
8794 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
8796 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
8797 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
8798 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
8803 .. code-block:: llvm
8806 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
8810 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
8811 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
8812 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
8813 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
8814 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
8815 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
8822 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction
8823 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8830 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields ty
8835 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
8840 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
8841 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
8842 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
8858 For most of these operations, the type of '<value>' must be an integer
8859 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight
8860 and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. For xchg, this
8861 may also be a floating point type with the same size constraints as
8862 integers. For fadd/fsub, this must be a floating point type. The
8863 type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must be a pointer to that type. If
8864 the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8865 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this
8866 ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8868 A ``atomicrmw`` instruction can also take an optional
8869 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8874 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
8875 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
8876 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
8879 - xchg: ``*ptr = val``
8880 - add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
8881 - sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
8882 - and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
8883 - nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
8884 - or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
8885 - xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
8886 - max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8887 - min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8888 - umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8890 - umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8892 - fadd: ``*ptr = *ptr + val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8893 - fsub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8898 .. code-block:: llvm
8900 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
8902 .. _i_getelementptr:
8904 '``getelementptr``' Instruction
8905 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8912 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8913 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8914 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, [inrange] <vector index type> <idx>
8919 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
8920 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
8921 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
8922 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
8927 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
8928 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
8929 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
8930 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
8931 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
8932 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
8933 second argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
8934 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
8935 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
8936 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
8937 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
8938 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
8940 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
8941 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
8942 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
8943 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
8944 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
8945 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
8948 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
8964 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
8965 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
8968 The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
8970 .. code-block:: llvm
8972 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
8973 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
8975 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
8977 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
8984 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
8985 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
8986 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
8987 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
8988 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
8989 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
8990 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
8991 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
8992 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
8993 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
8995 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
8996 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
8997 for the given testcase is equivalent to:
8999 .. code-block:: llvm
9001 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
9002 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
9003 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
9004 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
9005 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
9006 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
9010 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
9011 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
9012 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
9013 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
9014 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
9015 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
9016 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
9017 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
9018 past the end. The only *in bounds* address for a null pointer in the
9019 default address-space is the null pointer itself. In cases where the
9020 base is a vector of pointers the ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each
9021 of the computations element-wise.
9023 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
9024 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
9025 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
9026 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
9027 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
9028 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
9029 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
9030 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
9033 If the ``inrange`` keyword is present before any index, loading from or
9034 storing to any pointer derived from the ``getelementptr`` has undefined
9035 behavior if the load or store would access memory outside of the bounds of
9036 the element selected by the index marked as ``inrange``. The result of a
9037 pointer comparison or ``ptrtoint`` (including ``ptrtoint``-like operations
9038 involving memory) involving a pointer derived from a ``getelementptr`` with
9039 the ``inrange`` keyword is undefined, with the exception of comparisons
9040 in the case where both operands are in the range of the element selected
9041 by the ``inrange`` keyword, inclusive of the address one past the end of
9042 that element. Note that the ``inrange`` keyword is currently only allowed
9043 in constant ``getelementptr`` expressions.
9045 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
9046 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
9051 .. code-block:: llvm
9053 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
9054 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
9056 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
9058 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
9060 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
9065 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
9066 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
9067 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
9068 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
9070 .. code-block:: llvm
9072 ; All arguments are vectors:
9073 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
9074 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
9076 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
9077 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
9078 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
9080 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
9081 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
9082 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
9084 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
9086 The two following instructions are equivalent:
9088 .. code-block:: llvm
9090 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
9091 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
9092 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
9094 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
9096 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
9097 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
9099 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
9104 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
9105 double *A, *B; int *C;
9106 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
9110 .. code-block:: llvm
9112 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
9113 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
9114 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
9115 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64.v8p0f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
9116 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
9118 Conversion Operations
9119 ---------------------
9121 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
9122 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
9123 various bit conversions on the operand.
9127 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction
9128 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9135 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9140 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
9145 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
9146 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
9147 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9148 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
9149 types are not allowed.
9154 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
9155 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
9156 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
9157 It will always truncate bits.
9162 .. code-block:: llvm
9164 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
9165 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
9166 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
9167 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
9171 '``zext .. to``' Instruction
9172 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9179 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9184 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
9189 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9190 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9191 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9192 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9197 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
9198 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9200 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
9205 .. code-block:: llvm
9207 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
9208 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
9209 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9213 '``sext .. to``' Instruction
9214 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9221 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9226 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
9231 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9232 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9233 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9234 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9239 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
9240 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
9241 of the type ``ty2``.
9243 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
9248 .. code-block:: llvm
9250 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
9251 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
9252 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9254 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
9255 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9262 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9267 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9272 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9273 value to cast and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
9274 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
9275 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
9280 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
9281 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating-point
9283 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
9284 environment <floatenv>`.
9289 .. code-block:: llvm
9291 %X = fptrunc double 16777217.0 to float ; yields float:16777216.0
9292 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to half ; yields half:+infinity
9294 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction
9295 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9302 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9307 The '``fpext``' extends a floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point
9313 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9314 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it
9315 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
9320 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
9321 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating-point
9322 <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
9323 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
9324 *no-op cast* for a floating-point cast.
9329 .. code-block:: llvm
9331 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
9332 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
9334 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
9335 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9342 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9347 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating-point ``value`` to its unsigned
9348 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
9353 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9354 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9355 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9356 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9357 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9362 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9363 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9364 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9365 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9370 .. code-block:: llvm
9372 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
9373 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9374 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9376 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
9377 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9384 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9389 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9390 ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9395 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9396 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9397 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9398 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9399 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9404 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9405 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9406 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9407 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9412 .. code-block:: llvm
9414 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
9415 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9416 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9418 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
9419 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9426 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9431 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
9432 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9437 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9438 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9439 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9440 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9441 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9446 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
9447 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point
9448 value. If the value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using
9449 the default rounding mode.
9455 .. code-block:: llvm
9457 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9458 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
9460 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
9461 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9468 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9473 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
9474 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9479 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9480 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9481 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9482 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9483 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9488 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
9489 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point value. If the
9490 value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using the default rounding
9496 .. code-block:: llvm
9498 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9499 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
9503 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
9504 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9511 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9516 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
9517 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
9522 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
9523 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
9524 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9525 a vector of integers type.
9530 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
9531 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
9532 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
9533 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
9534 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
9535 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
9541 .. code-block:: llvm
9543 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9544 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
9545 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
9549 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
9550 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9557 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9562 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
9563 pointer type, ``ty2``.
9568 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
9569 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
9575 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
9576 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
9577 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
9578 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
9579 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
9580 nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
9585 .. code-block:: llvm
9587 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
9588 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
9589 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9590 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
9594 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
9595 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9602 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9607 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
9613 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9614 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
9615 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
9616 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
9617 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
9618 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
9619 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
9620 long as they have the same size).
9625 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
9626 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
9627 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
9628 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
9629 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
9630 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
9631 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
9632 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
9637 .. code-block:: text
9639 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
9640 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
9641 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
9642 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
9644 .. _i_addrspacecast:
9646 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
9647 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9654 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
9659 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
9660 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
9665 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
9666 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
9672 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
9673 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
9674 value modification, depending on the target and the address space
9675 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
9676 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
9677 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
9683 .. code-block:: llvm
9685 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
9686 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
9687 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
9694 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
9695 which defy better classification.
9699 '``icmp``' Instruction
9700 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9707 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9712 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
9713 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
9714 pointer, or pointer vector operands.
9719 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9720 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9721 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9724 #. ``ne``: not equal
9725 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
9726 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
9727 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than
9728 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
9729 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than
9730 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
9731 #. ``slt``: signed less than
9732 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal
9734 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9735 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
9736 must also be identical types.
9741 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
9742 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
9743 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
9745 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
9746 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9747 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
9748 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9749 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9750 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9751 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9752 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9753 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9754 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9755 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9756 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9757 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9758 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9759 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9760 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9761 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9762 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9763 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9764 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9766 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
9767 are compared as if they were integers.
9769 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
9770 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
9771 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
9776 .. code-block:: text
9778 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9779 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
9780 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
9781 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9782 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9783 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9787 '``fcmp``' Instruction
9788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9795 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9800 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
9801 values based on comparison of its operands.
9803 If the operands are floating-point scalars, then the result type is a
9804 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
9806 If the operands are floating-point vectors, then the result type is a
9807 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
9813 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9814 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9815 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9817 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
9818 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
9819 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
9820 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
9821 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than
9822 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
9823 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal
9824 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
9825 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
9826 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
9827 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
9828 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than
9829 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
9830 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal
9831 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
9832 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
9834 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
9835 that either operand may be a QNAN.
9837 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating-point
9838 <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating-point type.
9839 They must have identical types.
9844 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
9845 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
9846 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
9847 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
9849 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
9850 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9851 is equal to ``op2``.
9852 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9853 is greater than ``op2``.
9854 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9855 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9856 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9857 is less than ``op2``.
9858 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9859 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9860 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9861 is not equal to ``op2``.
9862 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
9863 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9865 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9866 greater than ``op2``.
9867 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9868 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9869 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9871 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9872 less than or equal to ``op2``.
9873 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9874 not equal to ``op2``.
9875 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
9876 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
9878 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
9879 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9880 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations.
9882 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
9883 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
9884 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
9885 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``reassoc``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
9890 .. code-block:: text
9892 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
9893 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9894 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9895 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
9899 '``phi``' Instruction
9900 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9907 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
9912 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
9913 graph representing the function.
9918 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
9919 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
9920 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
9921 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
9922 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
9925 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
9926 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
9929 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
9930 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
9931 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
9932 instruction's return value on the same edge).
9937 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
9938 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
9939 executed just prior to the current block.
9944 .. code-block:: llvm
9946 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
9947 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
9948 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
9953 '``select``' Instruction
9954 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9961 <result> = select [fast-math flags] selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
9963 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
9968 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
9969 condition, without IR-level branching.
9974 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
9975 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
9976 class <t_firstclass>` type.
9978 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the select has one or more
9979 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`. These are optimization hints to enable
9980 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
9981 for selects that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
9986 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
9987 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
9990 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
9991 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
9993 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
9994 same size, then an entire vector is selected.
9999 .. code-block:: llvm
10001 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
10005 '``call``' Instruction
10006 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10013 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)]
10014 [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs] [ operand bundles ]
10019 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
10024 This instruction requires several arguments:
10026 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
10027 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
10028 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
10029 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
10030 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
10032 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
10033 recursive cycle in the call graph.
10034 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
10035 forwarded in place.
10036 #. If the musttail call appears in a function with the ``"thunk"`` attribute
10037 and the caller and callee both have varargs, than any unprototyped
10038 arguments in register or memory are forwarded to the callee. Similarly,
10039 the return value of the callee is returned the the caller's caller, even
10040 if a void return type is in use.
10042 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas from the caller.
10043 The ``tail`` marker additionally implies that the callee does not access
10044 varargs from the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following
10047 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
10048 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
10049 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
10050 produced by the call or void.
10051 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
10052 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
10054 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
10055 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
10056 returned, and inalloca, must match.
10057 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
10058 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
10059 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
10061 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
10062 the following conditions are met:
10064 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
10065 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
10066 uses value of call or is void).
10067 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
10068 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
10069 - `Platform-specific constraints are
10070 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
10072 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
10073 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
10074 call optimization from being performed on the call.
10076 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
10077 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
10078 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
10079 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
10081 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
10082 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
10083 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
10084 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
10085 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
10086 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
10087 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
10089 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
10090 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
10091 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
10092 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
10093 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
10095 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
10096 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
10097 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
10098 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
10099 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
10100 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
10102 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
10103 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
10104 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
10105 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
10106 extra arguments can be specified.
10107 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
10108 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
10113 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
10114 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
10115 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
10116 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
10117 return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
10122 .. code-block:: llvm
10124 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
10125 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
10126 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
10127 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
10128 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
10130 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
10131 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
10132 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
10133 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
10134 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
10135 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
10137 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
10138 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
10139 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
10140 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
10141 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
10145 '``va_arg``' Instruction
10146 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10153 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
10158 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
10159 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
10160 the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
10165 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
10166 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
10167 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
10168 type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
10173 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
10174 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
10175 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
10176 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
10178 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
10179 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
10182 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
10183 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
10188 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
10190 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
10191 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
10192 types on any target.
10196 '``landingpad``' Instruction
10197 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10204 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
10205 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
10207 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
10208 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
10213 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10214 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10215 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
10216 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
10217 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
10218 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
10224 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
10226 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
10227 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
10228 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
10229 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
10230 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
10231 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
10232 the ``cleanup`` flag.
10237 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
10238 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
10239 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
10240 calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10241 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10243 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
10244 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
10245 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
10246 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10247 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
10248 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
10249 unwinding continues further up the call stack.
10251 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10253 - A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
10254 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
10255 - A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
10256 first non-PHI instruction.
10257 - There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
10259 - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
10260 '``landingpad``' instruction.
10265 .. code-block:: llvm
10267 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
10268 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10270 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
10271 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10273 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
10274 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10276 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
10280 '``catchpad``' Instruction
10281 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10288 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
10293 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10294 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10295 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
10296 control to catch an exception.
10301 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
10302 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
10303 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
10304 terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
10306 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
10307 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
10308 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
10311 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
10312 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
10318 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
10319 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
10320 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
10321 entirely target and personality function-specific.
10323 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
10324 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
10326 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
10327 instructions is described in the
10328 `Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
10330 When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10331 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10332 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10333 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10338 .. code-block:: text
10341 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
10342 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
10344 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
10348 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction
10349 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10356 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
10361 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10362 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10363 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
10364 transfer control to run cleanup actions.
10365 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
10366 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
10367 execute the cleanup.
10368 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
10369 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
10370 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
10371 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
10372 this operand may be the token ``none``.
10377 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
10378 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
10383 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10384 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
10385 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
10386 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10387 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10389 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10391 - A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
10392 an exceptional instruction.
10393 - A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
10394 first non-PHI instruction.
10395 - There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
10397 - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
10398 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
10400 When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10401 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10402 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10403 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10408 .. code-block:: text
10410 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
10414 Intrinsic Functions
10415 ===================
10417 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
10418 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
10419 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
10420 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
10421 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
10422 reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
10424 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
10425 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
10426 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
10427 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
10428 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
10429 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
10430 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
10431 are added that they be documented here.
10433 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
10434 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
10435 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
10436 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
10437 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
10438 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
10439 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
10440 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
10441 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
10442 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
10443 argument or the result.
10445 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
10446 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
10447 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
10448 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
10449 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
10450 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
10451 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
10452 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
10453 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
10454 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
10457 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
10458 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
10462 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
10463 -------------------------------------
10465 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
10466 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
10467 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
10468 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
10470 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
10471 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
10472 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
10473 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
10475 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
10476 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
10478 .. code-block:: llvm
10480 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
10481 ; it is merely an i8*.
10482 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
10484 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
10485 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
10487 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
10488 ; Initialize variable argument processing
10489 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
10490 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
10491 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
10493 ; Read a single integer argument
10494 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
10496 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
10498 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
10499 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
10500 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
10502 ; Stop processing of arguments.
10503 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
10507 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
10508 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
10509 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
10513 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
10514 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10521 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
10526 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
10527 subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
10532 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10537 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
10538 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
10539 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
10540 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
10541 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
10542 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
10545 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
10546 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10553 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
10558 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
10559 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
10564 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
10569 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
10570 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
10571 element to which the argument points. Calls to
10572 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
10573 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
10578 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
10579 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10586 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
10591 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
10592 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
10597 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10598 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
10603 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
10604 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
10605 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
10606 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
10607 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
10609 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
10610 --------------------------------------
10612 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
10613 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
10614 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
10615 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
10617 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
10618 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
10619 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
10620 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
10621 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
10622 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
10624 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
10625 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10627 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
10628 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
10629 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
10630 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
10631 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
10632 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
10633 described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
10637 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
10638 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10645 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
10650 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
10651 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
10656 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
10657 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
10658 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
10664 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
10665 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
10666 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
10667 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
10668 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
10672 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
10673 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10680 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
10685 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
10686 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
10692 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
10693 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
10694 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
10695 runtime (otherwise null).
10700 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
10701 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10702 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
10703 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10708 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
10709 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10716 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
10721 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
10722 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
10723 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
10728 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
10729 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
10730 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
10731 object, Obj may be null.
10736 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
10737 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10738 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
10739 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10742 Code Generator Intrinsics
10743 -------------------------
10745 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
10746 may only be implemented with code generator support.
10748 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
10749 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10756 declare i8* @llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
10761 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
10762 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
10763 function or one of its callers.
10768 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10769 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
10770 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10776 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10777 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10778 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10779 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10780 used for debugging purposes.
10782 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10783 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10784 of the obvious source-language caller.
10786 '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' Intrinsic
10787 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10794 declare i8* @llvm.addressofreturnaddress()
10799 The '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' intrinsic returns a target-specific
10800 pointer to the place in the stack frame where the return address of the
10801 current function is stored.
10806 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10807 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10808 of the obvious source-language caller.
10810 This intrinsic is only implemented for x86 and aarch64.
10812 '``llvm.sponentry``' Intrinsic
10813 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10820 declare i8* @llvm.sponentry()
10825 The '``llvm.sponentry``' intrinsic returns the stack pointer value at
10826 the entry of the current function calling this intrinsic.
10831 Note this intrinsic is only verified on AArch64.
10833 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
10834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10841 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
10846 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
10847 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
10852 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10853 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
10854 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10860 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10861 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10862 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10863 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10864 used for debugging purposes.
10866 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10867 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10868 of the obvious source-language caller.
10870 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
10871 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10878 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
10879 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
10884 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
10885 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
10886 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
10887 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
10892 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
10893 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
10894 once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
10896 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
10897 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
10898 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
10901 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
10902 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
10903 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
10904 pointer in platform-specific ways.
10906 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
10907 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
10912 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
10913 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
10914 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
10915 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
10916 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
10917 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
10918 '``llvm.localrecover``'.
10920 .. _int_read_register:
10921 .. _int_write_register:
10923 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
10924 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10931 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
10932 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
10933 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
10934 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
10940 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
10941 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
10942 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
10943 with the register being read.
10948 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
10949 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
10950 the current value of the register, where possible.
10952 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
10953 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
10954 bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
10956 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
10957 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
10958 allocatable registers are not supported.
10960 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
10961 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
10962 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
10967 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
10968 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10975 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
10980 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
10981 of the function stack, for use with
10982 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
10983 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
10989 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
10990 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
10991 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
10992 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
10993 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
10994 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
10995 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
10997 .. _int_stackrestore:
10999 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
11000 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11007 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
11012 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
11013 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
11014 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
11015 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
11016 sized arrays in C99.
11021 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
11023 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
11025 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
11026 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11033 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
11034 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
11039 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
11040 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
11041 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
11042 intendend for use in combination with
11043 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
11044 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
11045 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
11050 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
11051 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
11052 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
11053 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
11054 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
11055 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
11056 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
11058 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
11059 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
11060 compile-time-known constant value.
11062 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
11063 must match the target's default address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
11065 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
11066 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11073 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
11078 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
11079 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
11080 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
11081 its performance characteristics.
11086 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
11087 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
11088 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
11089 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
11090 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
11091 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
11092 arguments must be constant integers.
11097 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
11098 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
11099 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
11100 the processor cache for better performance.
11102 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
11103 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11110 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
11115 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
11116 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
11117 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
11118 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
11119 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
11120 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
11121 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
11122 allow correlations of simulation runs.
11127 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
11132 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
11133 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
11135 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
11136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11143 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
11148 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
11149 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
11150 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
11151 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
11152 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
11158 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
11159 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
11160 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
11161 is lowered to a constant 0.
11163 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
11164 running at and the host platform.
11166 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
11167 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11174 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
11179 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
11180 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
11181 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
11182 flushes the instruction cache.
11187 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
11188 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
11189 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
11190 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
11193 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
11196 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
11197 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
11199 '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' Intrinsic
11200 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11207 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11208 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
11213 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11214 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
11215 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
11216 program at runtime.
11221 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11222 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
11223 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11225 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11226 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
11227 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
11228 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
11229 ``instrprof.increment`` that refer to the same name.
11231 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
11232 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
11237 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
11238 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
11239 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
11240 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
11241 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
11243 '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' Intrinsic
11244 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11251 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment.step(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11252 i32 <num-counters>,
11253 i32 <index>, i64 <step>)
11258 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' intrinsic is an extension to
11259 the '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic with an additional fifth
11260 argument to specify the step of the increment.
11264 The first four arguments are the same as '``llvm.instrprof.increment``'
11267 The last argument specifies the value of the increment of the counter variable.
11271 See description of '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' instrinsic.
11274 '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' Intrinsic
11275 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11282 declare void @llvm.instrprof.value.profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11283 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
11289 The '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11290 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
11291 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
11292 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
11297 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11298 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
11299 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11301 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11302 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
11303 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
11304 ``llvm.instrprof.*`` that refer to the same name.
11306 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
11307 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
11308 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
11309 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
11310 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
11311 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
11312 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
11317 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
11318 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
11319 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
11320 ``llvm.instrprof.value.profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
11321 runtime library with proper arguments.
11323 '``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
11324 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11331 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
11336 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
11342 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
11343 for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
11344 specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
11345 in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
11346 call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
11347 other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
11350 Standard C Library Intrinsics
11351 -----------------------------
11353 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
11354 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
11355 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
11356 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
11360 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
11361 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11366 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
11367 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
11368 support all bit widths however.
11372 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11373 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11374 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11375 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11380 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11381 source location to the destination location.
11383 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
11384 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra isvolatile
11385 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11390 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11391 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11392 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11393 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11395 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11396 for the first and second arguments.
11398 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
11399 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11400 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11405 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11406 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
11407 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
11408 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11411 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11412 be appropriately aligned.
11416 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
11417 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11422 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
11423 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
11424 bit widths however.
11428 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11429 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11430 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11431 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11436 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
11437 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
11438 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
11441 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
11442 intrinsics do not return a value, takes an extra isvolatile
11443 argument and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11448 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11449 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11450 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11451 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11453 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11454 for the first and second arguments.
11456 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
11457 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
11458 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11463 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11464 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
11465 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
11466 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11469 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11470 be appropriately aligned.
11474 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
11475 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11480 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
11481 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
11482 support all bit widths.
11486 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11487 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11488 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11489 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11494 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
11495 particular byte value.
11497 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
11498 intrinsic does not return a value and takes an extra volatile
11499 argument. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
11504 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
11505 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
11506 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
11507 is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
11509 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11510 for the first arguments.
11512 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
11513 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11514 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11519 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
11520 at the destination location. If the argument is known to be
11521 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as an attribute on
11524 If "len" is 0, the pointers may be NULL or dangling. However, they must still
11525 be appropriately aligned.
11527 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
11528 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11533 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
11534 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11539 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
11540 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
11541 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11542 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
11543 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11548 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the square root of the specified value.
11553 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11558 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sqrt``' function but without
11559 trapping or setting ``errno``. For types specified by IEEE-754, the result
11560 matches a conforming libm implementation.
11562 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11563 using a less accurate calculation.
11565 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
11566 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11571 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
11572 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11577 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
11578 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
11579 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
11580 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11581 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11586 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11587 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
11588 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating-point type is
11589 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
11594 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
11595 raise to that power.
11600 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
11601 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
11603 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
11604 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11609 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
11610 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11615 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
11616 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
11617 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11618 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
11619 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11624 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
11629 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11634 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sin``' function but without
11635 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11637 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11638 using a less accurate calculation.
11640 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
11641 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11646 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
11647 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11652 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
11653 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
11654 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11655 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
11656 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11661 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
11666 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11671 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``cos``' function but without
11672 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11674 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11675 using a less accurate calculation.
11677 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
11678 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11683 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
11684 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11689 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
11690 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
11691 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
11692 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
11693 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
11698 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11699 specified (positive or negative) power.
11704 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11709 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``pow``' function but without
11710 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11712 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11713 using a less accurate calculation.
11715 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
11716 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11721 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
11722 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11727 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
11728 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
11729 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11730 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
11731 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11736 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e exponential of the specified
11742 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11747 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp``' function but without
11748 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11750 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11751 using a less accurate calculation.
11753 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
11754 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11759 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
11760 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11765 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
11766 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
11767 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11768 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11769 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11774 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 exponential of the
11780 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11785 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp2``' function but without
11786 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11788 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11789 using a less accurate calculation.
11791 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
11792 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11797 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
11798 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11803 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
11804 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
11805 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11806 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
11807 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11812 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e logarithm of the specified
11818 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11823 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log``' function but without
11824 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11826 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11827 using a less accurate calculation.
11829 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
11830 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11835 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
11836 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11841 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
11842 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
11843 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11844 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
11845 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11850 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics compute the base-10 logarithm of the
11856 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11861 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log10``' function but without
11862 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11864 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11865 using a less accurate calculation.
11867 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
11868 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11873 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
11874 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11879 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
11880 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
11881 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11882 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11883 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11888 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 logarithm of the specified
11894 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11899 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log2``' function but without
11900 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11902 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11903 using a less accurate calculation.
11905 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
11906 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11911 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
11912 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11917 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11918 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11919 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
11920 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
11921 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
11926 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add operation.
11931 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11936 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``fma``' function but without
11937 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11939 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11940 using a less accurate calculation.
11942 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
11943 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11948 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
11949 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11954 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
11955 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
11956 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11957 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
11958 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11963 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
11969 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11975 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
11976 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11978 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
11979 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11984 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
11985 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11990 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11991 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11992 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11993 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11994 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11999 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
12006 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12012 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, except for handling of
12013 signaling NaNs. This match's the behavior of libm's fmin.
12015 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
12016 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
12017 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
12018 equal to both operands. This means that fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
12019 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
12021 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
12022 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
12023 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
12024 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
12025 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
12026 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
12029 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
12030 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12035 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
12036 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12041 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
12042 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12043 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12044 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12045 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12050 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
12057 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12062 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum except for the handling of
12063 signaling NaNs. This matches the behavior of libm's fmax.
12065 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
12066 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
12067 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
12068 equal to both operands. This means that fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
12069 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
12071 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
12072 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
12073 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
12074 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
12075 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
12076 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
12078 '``llvm.minimum.*``' Intrinsic
12079 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12084 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minimum`` on any
12085 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12090 declare float @llvm.minimum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
12091 declare double @llvm.minimum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12092 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minimum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12093 declare fp128 @llvm.minimum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12094 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minimum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12099 The '``llvm.minimum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
12100 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
12106 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12111 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the lesser
12112 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
12113 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
12116 '``llvm.maximum.*``' Intrinsic
12117 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12122 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maximum`` on any
12123 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12128 declare float @llvm.maximum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
12129 declare double @llvm.maximum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
12130 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maximum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
12131 declare fp128 @llvm.maximum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
12132 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maximum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
12137 The '``llvm.maximum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
12138 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
12144 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12149 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the greater
12150 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
12151 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
12154 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
12155 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12160 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
12161 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12166 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
12167 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
12168 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
12169 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
12170 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
12175 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
12176 first operand and the sign of the second operand.
12181 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12187 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
12188 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12190 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
12191 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12196 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
12197 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12202 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
12203 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
12204 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12205 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
12206 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12211 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
12216 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12222 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
12223 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12225 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
12226 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12231 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
12232 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12237 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
12238 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
12239 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12240 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
12241 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12246 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
12251 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12257 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
12258 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12260 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
12261 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12266 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
12267 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12272 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
12273 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
12274 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12275 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
12276 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12281 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12282 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
12287 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12293 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
12294 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12296 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
12297 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12302 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
12303 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12308 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
12309 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
12310 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12311 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12312 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12317 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12318 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
12319 operand isn't an integer.
12324 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12330 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
12331 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12333 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
12334 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12339 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
12340 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12345 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
12346 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
12347 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12348 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12349 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12354 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12360 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12366 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
12367 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12369 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
12370 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12375 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
12376 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12381 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
12382 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
12383 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12384 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
12385 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12390 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12396 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12402 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
12403 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12405 '``llvm.lround.*``' Intrinsic
12406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12411 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.lround`` on any
12412 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12416 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f32(float %Val)
12417 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f64(double %Val)
12418 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f80(float %Val)
12419 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.f128(double %Val)
12420 declare i32 @llvm.lround.i32.ppcf128(double %Val)
12422 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f32(float %Val)
12423 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f64(double %Val)
12424 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f80(float %Val)
12425 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f128(double %Val)
12426 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12431 The '``llvm.lround.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12437 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12442 This function returns the same values as the libm ``lround``
12443 functions would, but without setting errno.
12445 '``llvm.llround.*``' Intrinsic
12446 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12451 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.llround`` on any
12452 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12456 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f32(float %Val)
12457 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f64(double %Val)
12458 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f80(float %Val)
12459 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.f128(double %Val)
12460 declare i64 @llvm.lround.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12465 The '``llvm.llround.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12471 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12476 This function returns the same values as the libm ``llround``
12477 functions would, but without setting errno.
12479 '``llvm.lrint.*``' Intrinsic
12480 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12485 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.lrint`` on any
12486 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12490 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f32(float %Val)
12491 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f64(double %Val)
12492 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f80(float %Val)
12493 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.f128(double %Val)
12494 declare i32 @llvm.lrint.i32.ppcf128(double %Val)
12496 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f32(float %Val)
12497 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f64(double %Val)
12498 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f80(float %Val)
12499 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.f128(double %Val)
12500 declare i64 @llvm.lrint.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12505 The '``llvm.lrint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12511 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12516 This function returns the same values as the libm ``lrint``
12517 functions would, but without setting errno.
12519 '``llvm.llrint.*``' Intrinsic
12520 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12525 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.llrint`` on any
12526 floating-point type. Not all targets support all types however.
12530 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f32(float %Val)
12531 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f64(double %Val)
12532 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f80(float %Val)
12533 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.f128(double %Val)
12534 declare i64 @llvm.llrint.i64.ppcf128(double %Val)
12539 The '``llvm.llrint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12545 The argument is a floating-point number and return is an integer type.
12550 This function returns the same values as the libm ``llrint``
12551 functions would, but without setting errno.
12553 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
12554 ---------------------------
12556 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
12557 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
12559 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
12560 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12565 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
12570 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
12571 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
12572 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
12573 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bitreverse.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12578 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
12579 bitpattern of an integer value or vector of integer values; for example
12580 ``0b10110110`` becomes ``0b01101101``.
12585 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an iN value that has bit
12586 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output. The vector
12587 intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bitreverse.v4i32``, operate on a per-element
12588 basis and the element order is not affected.
12590 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
12591 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12596 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
12597 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
12601 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
12602 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
12603 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
12604 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bswap.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12609 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap an integer
12610 value or vector of integer values with an even number of bytes (positive
12611 multiple of 16 bits).
12616 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
12617 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
12618 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
12619 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
12620 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
12621 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
12622 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
12623 respectively). The vector intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bswap.v4i32``,
12624 operate on a per-element basis and the element order is not affected.
12626 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
12627 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12632 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
12633 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
12634 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12638 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
12639 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
12640 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
12641 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
12642 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
12643 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
12648 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
12654 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
12655 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
12656 match the argument type.
12661 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
12662 each element of a vector.
12664 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
12665 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12670 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
12671 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
12672 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12676 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12677 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12678 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12679 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12680 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12681 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12686 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12687 leading zeros in a variable.
12692 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12693 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12694 type must match the first argument type.
12696 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12697 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12698 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12699 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12700 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12705 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
12706 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
12707 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
12708 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12709 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
12711 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
12712 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12717 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
12718 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12719 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12723 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12724 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12725 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12726 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12727 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12728 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12733 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12739 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12740 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12741 type must match the first argument type.
12743 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12744 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12745 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12746 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12747 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12752 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
12753 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
12754 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
12755 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12756 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
12760 '``llvm.fshl.*``' Intrinsic
12761 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12766 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshl`` on any
12767 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12768 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12772 declare i8 @llvm.fshl.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12773 declare i67 @llvm.fshl.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12774 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshl.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12779 The '``llvm.fshl``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift left:
12780 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12781 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted left, and the most
12782 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12783 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12784 to a rotate left operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12785 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12786 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12791 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12792 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12793 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12794 have the same type.
12799 .. code-block:: text
12801 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: msb_extract((concat(x, y) << (z % 8)), 8)
12802 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 128 (0b10000000)
12803 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 120 (0b01111000)
12804 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 0 (0b00000000)
12806 '``llvm.fshr.*``' Intrinsic
12807 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12812 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshr`` on any
12813 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12814 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12818 declare i8 @llvm.fshr.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12819 declare i67 @llvm.fshr.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12820 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshr.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12825 The '``llvm.fshr``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift right:
12826 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12827 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted right, and the least
12828 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12829 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12830 to a rotate right operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12831 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12832 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12837 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12838 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12839 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12840 have the same type.
12845 .. code-block:: text
12847 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: lsb_extract((concat(x, y) >> (z % 8)), 8)
12848 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 254 (0b11111110)
12849 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 225 (0b11100001)
12850 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 255 (0b11111111)
12852 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
12853 -----------------------------------
12855 LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
12857 Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
12858 element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
12859 arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
12860 the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
12861 returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
12862 result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
12863 the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
12865 The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
12866 arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
12867 overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
12868 any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
12869 not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
12870 ``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
12871 ``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
12873 The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
12876 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12877 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12882 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
12883 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12887 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12888 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12889 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12890 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12895 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12896 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
12897 occurred during the signed summation.
12902 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12903 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12904 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12905 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12911 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12912 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
12913 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
12914 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
12920 .. code-block:: llvm
12922 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12923 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12924 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12925 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12927 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12928 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12933 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
12934 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12938 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12939 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12940 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12941 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12946 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12947 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
12948 occurred during the unsigned summation.
12953 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12954 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12955 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12956 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12962 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12963 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
12964 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
12965 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
12970 .. code-block:: llvm
12972 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12973 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12974 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12975 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
12977 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12978 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12983 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
12984 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12988 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12989 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12990 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12991 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12996 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12997 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12998 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
13003 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13004 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13005 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13006 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
13012 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13013 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
13014 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
13015 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
13021 .. code-block:: llvm
13023 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13024 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13025 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13026 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13028 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13029 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13034 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
13035 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13039 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13040 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13041 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13042 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13047 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13048 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13049 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
13054 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13055 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13056 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13057 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
13063 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13064 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13065 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
13066 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
13072 .. code-block:: llvm
13074 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13075 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13076 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13077 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13079 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13080 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13085 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
13086 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13090 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13091 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13092 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13093 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13098 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13099 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13100 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
13105 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13106 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13107 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13108 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
13114 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13115 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13116 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
13117 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
13123 .. code-block:: llvm
13125 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13126 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13127 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13128 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13130 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
13131 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13136 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
13137 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13141 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13142 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13143 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13144 declare {<4 x i32>, <4 x i1>} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13149 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13150 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
13151 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
13156 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
13157 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
13158 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
13159 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
13165 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
13166 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
13167 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
13168 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
13169 resulted in an overflow.
13174 .. code-block:: llvm
13176 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13177 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
13178 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
13179 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
13181 Saturation Arithmetic Intrinsics
13182 ---------------------------------
13184 Saturation arithmetic is a version of arithmetic in which operations are
13185 limited to a fixed range between a minimum and maximum value. If the result of
13186 an operation is greater than the maximum value, the result is set (or
13187 "clamped") to this maximum. If it is below the minimum, it is clamped to this
13191 '``llvm.sadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13192 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13197 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.sat``
13198 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13202 declare i16 @llvm.sadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13203 declare i32 @llvm.sadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13204 declare i64 @llvm.sadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13205 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.sadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13210 The '``llvm.sadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13211 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
13216 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13217 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13218 values that will undergo signed addition.
13223 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13224 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
13225 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13231 .. code-block:: llvm
13233 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
13234 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 7
13235 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 2) ; %res = -2
13236 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 -5) ; %res = -8
13239 '``llvm.uadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13240 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13245 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.sat``
13246 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13250 declare i16 @llvm.uadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13251 declare i32 @llvm.uadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13252 declare i64 @llvm.uadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13253 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.uadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13258 The '``llvm.uadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13259 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
13264 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13265 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13266 values that will undergo unsigned addition.
13271 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest unsigned value
13272 representable by the bit width of the arguments. Because this is an unsigned
13273 operation, the result will never saturate towards zero.
13279 .. code-block:: llvm
13281 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
13282 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 11
13283 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 8, i4 8) ; %res = 15
13286 '``llvm.ssub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13287 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13292 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.sat``
13293 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13297 declare i16 @llvm.ssub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13298 declare i32 @llvm.ssub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13299 declare i64 @llvm.ssub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13300 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.ssub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13305 The '``llvm.ssub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13306 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
13311 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13312 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13313 values that will undergo signed subtraction.
13318 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13319 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
13320 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13326 .. code-block:: llvm
13328 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13329 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = -4
13330 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 5) ; %res = -8
13331 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 4, i4 -5) ; %res = 7
13334 '``llvm.usub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13335 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13340 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.sat``
13341 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13345 declare i16 @llvm.usub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13346 declare i32 @llvm.usub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13347 declare i64 @llvm.usub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13348 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.usub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13353 The '``llvm.usub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13354 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
13359 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13360 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13361 values that will undergo unsigned subtraction.
13366 The minimum value this operation can clamp to is 0, which is the smallest
13367 unsigned value representable by the bit width of the unsigned arguments.
13368 Because this is an unsigned operation, the result will never saturate towards
13369 the largest possible value representable by this bit width.
13375 .. code-block:: llvm
13377 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13378 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = 0
13381 Fixed Point Arithmetic Intrinsics
13382 ---------------------------------
13384 A fixed point number represents a real data type for a number that has a fixed
13385 number of digits after a radix point (equivalent to the decimal point '.').
13386 The number of digits after the radix point is referred as the ``scale``. These
13387 are useful for representing fractional values to a specific precision. The
13388 following intrinsics perform fixed point arithmetic operations on 2 operands
13389 of the same scale, specified as the third argument.
13391 The `llvm.*mul.fix` family of intrinsic functions represents a multiplication
13392 of fixed point numbers through scaled integers. Therefore, fixed point
13393 multplication can be represented as
13396 %result = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 %a, i4 %b, i32 %scale)
13399 %a2 = sext i4 %a to i8
13400 %b2 = sext i4 %b to i8
13401 %mul = mul nsw nuw i8 %a, %b
13402 %scale2 = trunc i32 %scale to i8
13403 %r = ashr i8 %mul, i8 %scale2 ; this is for a target rounding down towards negative infinity
13404 %result = trunc i8 %r to i4
13406 For each of these functions, if the result cannot be represented exactly with
13407 the provided scale, the result is rounded. Rounding is unspecified since
13408 preferred rounding may vary for different targets. Rounding is specified
13409 through a target hook. Different pipelines should legalize or optimize this
13410 using the rounding specified by this hook if it is provided. Operations like
13411 constant folding, instruction combining, KnownBits, and ValueTracking should
13412 also use this hook, if provided, and not assume the direction of rounding. A
13413 rounded result must always be within one unit of precision from the true
13414 result. That is, the error between the returned result and the true result must
13415 be less than 1/2^(scale).
13418 '``llvm.smul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13419 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13424 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.fix``
13425 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13429 declare i16 @llvm.smul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13430 declare i32 @llvm.smul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13431 declare i64 @llvm.smul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13432 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.smul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13437 The '``llvm.smul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13438 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13443 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13444 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13445 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13446 values that will undergo signed fixed point multiplication. The argument
13447 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13453 This operation performs fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13454 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13455 in the third argument.
13457 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13458 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13459 direction is unspecified.
13461 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13462 the fixed point type.
13468 .. code-block:: llvm
13470 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13471 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13472 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -2, i32 1) ; %res = -3 (1.5 x -1 = -1.5)
13474 ; The result in the following could be rounded up to -2 or down to -2.5
13475 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -3, i32 1) ; %res = -5 (or -4) (1.5 x -1.5 = -2.25)
13478 '``llvm.umul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13479 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13484 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.fix``
13485 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13489 declare i16 @llvm.umul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13490 declare i32 @llvm.umul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13491 declare i64 @llvm.umul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13492 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.umul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13497 The '``llvm.umul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13498 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13503 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13504 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13505 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13506 values that will undergo unsigned fixed point multiplication. The argument
13507 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13513 This operation performs unsigned fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13514 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13515 in the third argument.
13517 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13518 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13519 direction is unspecified.
13521 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13522 the fixed point type.
13528 .. code-block:: llvm
13530 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13531 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13533 ; The result in the following could be rounded down to 3.5 or up to 4
13534 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 15, i4 1, i32 1) ; %res = 7 (or 8) (7.5 x 0.5 = 3.75)
13537 '``llvm.smul.fix.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13538 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13543 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.fix.sat``
13544 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13548 declare i16 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13549 declare i32 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13550 declare i64 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13551 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.smul.fix.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13556 The '``llvm.smul.fix.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13557 fixed point saturation multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13562 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13563 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13564 values that will undergo signed fixed point multiplication. The argument
13565 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13571 This operation performs fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13572 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13573 in the third argument.
13575 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13576 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13577 direction is unspecified.
13579 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
13580 representable by the bit width of the first 2 arguments. The minimum value is the
13581 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13587 .. code-block:: llvm
13589 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13590 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13591 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 -2, i32 1) ; %res = -3 (1.5 x -1 = -1.5)
13593 ; The result in the following could be rounded up to -2 or down to -2.5
13594 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 3, i4 -3, i32 1) ; %res = -5 (or -4) (1.5 x -1.5 = -2.25)
13597 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 7, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 7
13598 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 7, i4 2, i32 2) ; %res = 7
13599 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 -8, i4 2, i32 2) ; %res = -8
13600 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 -8, i4 -2, i32 2) ; %res = 7
13602 ; Scale can affect the saturation result
13603 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 4, i32 0) ; %res = 7 (2 x 4 -> clamped to 7)
13604 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 4, i32 1) ; %res = 4 (1 x 2 = 2)
13607 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
13608 ---------------------------------
13610 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
13611 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13618 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
13619 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
13624 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
13625 encoding of a floating-point number. This canonicalization is useful for
13626 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
13627 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
13631 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
13632 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
13633 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
13635 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
13636 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
13637 according to section 6.2.
13639 Examples of non-canonical encodings:
13641 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
13642 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
13643 - Many normal decimal floating-point numbers have non-canonical alternative
13645 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
13646 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
13647 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
13649 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
13650 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
13653 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
13654 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
13655 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
13656 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
13658 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
13660 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
13661 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
13664 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
13665 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
13667 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
13668 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
13669 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
13672 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
13674 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
13675 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
13676 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
13677 operations. That is, the bits of the floating-point value are not examined.
13679 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
13680 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13687 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
13688 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
13693 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
13694 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
13695 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
13696 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
13697 and add instructions.
13702 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
13703 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
13712 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
13714 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
13715 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
13716 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
13717 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
13718 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
13719 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
13724 .. code-block:: llvm
13726 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
13729 Experimental Vector Reduction Intrinsics
13730 ----------------------------------------
13732 Horizontal reductions of vectors can be expressed using the following
13733 intrinsics. Each one takes a vector operand as an input and applies its
13734 respective operation across all elements of the vector, returning a single
13735 scalar result of the same element type.
13738 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' Intrinsic
13739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13746 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13747 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13752 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``ADD``
13753 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13754 the element-type of the vector input.
13758 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13760 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' Intrinsic
13761 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13768 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
13769 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
13774 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13775 ``ADD`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13776 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13778 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
13779 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
13780 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
13781 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13786 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
13787 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
13788 when fast-math flags are used. The type of the accumulator matches the
13789 element-type of the vector input.
13791 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13796 .. code-block:: llvm
13798 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
13799 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13802 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' Intrinsic
13803 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13810 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13811 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13816 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``MUL``
13817 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13818 the element-type of the vector input.
13822 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13824 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' Intrinsic
13825 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13832 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
13833 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
13838 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13839 ``MUL`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13840 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13842 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
13843 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
13844 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
13845 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13850 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
13851 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
13852 when fast-math flags are used. The type of the accumulator matches the
13853 element-type of the vector input.
13855 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13860 .. code-block:: llvm
13862 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
13863 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13865 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' Intrinsic
13866 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13873 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13878 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``AND``
13879 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13880 the element-type of the vector input.
13884 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13886 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' Intrinsic
13887 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13894 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13899 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``OR`` reduction
13900 of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches the
13901 element-type of the vector input.
13905 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13907 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' Intrinsic
13908 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13915 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13920 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``XOR``
13921 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13922 the element-type of the vector input.
13926 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13928 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' Intrinsic
13929 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13936 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13941 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
13942 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13943 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13947 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13949 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' Intrinsic
13950 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13957 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13962 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
13963 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13964 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13968 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13970 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' Intrinsic
13971 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13978 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13983 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
13984 integer ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
13985 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
13989 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13991 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' Intrinsic
13992 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13999 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
14004 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
14005 integer ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
14006 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
14010 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
14012 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' Intrinsic
14013 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14020 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
14021 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
14026 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
14027 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14028 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14030 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
14031 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
14035 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
14037 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' Intrinsic
14038 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14045 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
14046 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
14051 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
14052 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
14053 matches the element-type of the vector input.
14055 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
14056 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
14060 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
14062 Half Precision Floating-Point Intrinsics
14063 ----------------------------------------
14065 For most target platforms, half precision floating-point is a
14066 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
14067 but does not support computation in the format.
14069 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating-point
14070 value as an i16, then convert it to float with
14071 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
14072 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
14073 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
14074 if needed, then converted to i16 with
14075 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
14078 .. _int_convert_to_fp16:
14080 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
14081 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14088 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
14089 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
14094 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
14095 conventional floating-point type to half precision floating-point format.
14100 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
14106 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
14107 conventional floating-point format to half precision floating-point format. The
14108 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
14113 .. code-block:: llvm
14115 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
14116 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
14118 .. _int_convert_from_fp16:
14120 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
14121 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14128 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
14129 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
14134 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
14135 conversion from half precision floating-point format to single precision
14136 floating-point format.
14141 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
14147 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
14148 conversion from half single precision floating-point format to single
14149 precision floating-point format. The input half-float value is
14150 represented by an ``i16`` value.
14155 .. code-block:: llvm
14157 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
14158 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
14160 .. _dbg_intrinsics:
14162 Debugger Intrinsics
14163 -------------------
14165 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
14166 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
14167 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_
14170 Exception Handling Intrinsics
14171 -----------------------------
14173 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
14174 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
14175 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_ document.
14177 .. _int_trampoline:
14179 Trampoline Intrinsics
14180 ---------------------
14182 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
14183 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
14184 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
14185 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
14186 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
14187 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
14188 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
14191 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
14192 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
14193 It can be created as follows:
14195 .. code-block:: llvm
14197 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
14198 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
14199 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
14200 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
14201 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
14203 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
14204 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
14208 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
14209 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14216 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
14221 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
14222 turning it into a trampoline.
14227 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
14228 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
14229 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
14230 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
14231 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
14232 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
14233 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
14234 bitcast to an ``i8*``.
14239 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
14240 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
14241 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
14242 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
14243 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
14244 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
14245 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
14246 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
14247 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
14248 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
14249 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
14250 pointer is undefined.
14254 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
14255 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14262 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
14267 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
14268 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
14273 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
14274 code filled in by a previous call to
14275 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
14280 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
14281 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
14282 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
14283 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
14284 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
14286 .. _int_mload_mstore:
14288 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
14289 ---------------------------------------
14291 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
14295 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
14296 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14300 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
14304 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14305 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
14306 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
14307 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
14308 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
14309 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
14314 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14320 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
14326 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
14327 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
14332 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
14334 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
14335 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14336 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
14340 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
14341 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14345 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
14349 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14350 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14351 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
14352 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14353 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
14354 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
14359 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
14364 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
14370 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14371 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
14375 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
14377 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
14378 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14379 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
14380 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
14383 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
14384 -------------------------------------------
14386 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
14390 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
14391 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14395 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
14399 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32.v16p0f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14400 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64.v2p1f64 (<2 x double addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
14401 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32.v8p0p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
14406 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14412 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
14418 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
14419 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
14424 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1> <i1 true, i1 true, i1 true, i1 true>, <4 x double> undef)
14426 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
14427 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
14428 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
14429 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
14430 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
14432 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
14433 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
14434 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
14435 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
14437 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
14438 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
14439 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
14440 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
14444 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
14445 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14449 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
14453 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14454 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32.v16p1f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14455 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64.v4p0p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
14460 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
14465 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
14471 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14475 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
14476 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
14478 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
14479 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
14480 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
14482 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
14483 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
14484 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
14486 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
14487 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
14488 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
14489 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
14491 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
14494 Masked Vector Expanding Load and Compressing Store Intrinsics
14495 -------------------------------------------------------------
14497 LLVM provides intrinsics for expanding load and compressing store operations. Data selected from a vector according to a mask is stored in consecutive memory addresses (compressed store), and vice-versa (expanding load). These operations effective map to "if (cond.i) a[j++] = v.i" and "if (cond.i) v.i = a[j++]" patterns, respectively. Note that when the mask starts with '1' bits followed by '0' bits, these operations are identical to :ref:`llvm.masked.store <int_mstore>` and :ref:`llvm.masked.load <int_mload>`.
14499 .. _int_expandload:
14501 '``llvm.masked.expandload.*``' Intrinsics
14502 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14506 This is an overloaded intrinsic. Several values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are loaded from consecutive memory addresses and stored into the elements of a vector according to the mask.
14510 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.expandload.v16f32 (float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14511 declare <2 x i64> @llvm.masked.expandload.v2i64 (i64* <ptr>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x i64> <passthru>)
14516 Reads a number of scalar values sequentially from memory location provided in '``ptr``' and spreads them in a vector. The '``mask``' holds a bit for each vector lane. The number of elements read from memory is equal to the number of '1' bits in the mask. The loaded elements are positioned in the destination vector according to the sequence of '1' and '0' bits in the mask. E.g., if the mask vector is '10010001', "explandload" reads 3 values from memory addresses ptr, ptr+1, ptr+2 and places them in lanes 0, 3 and 7 accordingly. The masked-off lanes are filled by elements from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14522 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. It has the same underlying type as the element of the returned vector. The second operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The third is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type and the type of the '``passthru``' operand have the same vector type.
14527 The '``llvm.masked.expandload``' intrinsic is designed for reading multiple scalar values from adjacent memory addresses into possibly non-adjacent vector lanes. It is useful for targets that support vector expanding loads and allows vectorizing loop with cross-iteration dependency like in the following example:
14531 // In this loop we load from B and spread the elements into array A.
14532 double *A, B; int *C;
14533 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14539 .. code-block:: llvm
14541 ; Load several elements from array B and expand them in a vector.
14542 ; The number of loaded elements is equal to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14543 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.expandload.v8f64(double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14544 ; Store the result in A
14545 call void @llvm.masked.store.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, <8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14547 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14548 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14549 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14550 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14551 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14554 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of conditional scalar load operations and shuffles.
14555 If all mask elements are '1', the intrinsic behavior is equivalent to the regular unmasked vector load.
14557 .. _int_compressstore:
14559 '``llvm.masked.compressstore.*``' Intrinsics
14560 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14564 This is an overloaded intrinsic. A number of scalar values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are collected from an input vector and stored into adjacent memory addresses. A mask defines which elements to collect from the vector.
14568 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, i32* <ptr>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14569 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14574 Selects elements from input vector '``value``' according to the '``mask``'. All selected elements are written into adjacent memory addresses starting at address '`ptr`', from lower to higher. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to select elements to be stored. The number of elements to be stored is equal to the number of active bits in the mask.
14579 The first operand is the input vector, from which elements are collected and written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the element of the input vector operand. The third operand is the mask, a vector of boolean values. The mask and the input vector must have the same number of vector elements.
14585 The '``llvm.masked.compressstore``' intrinsic is designed for compressing data in memory. It allows to collect elements from possibly non-adjacent lanes of a vector and store them contiguously in memory in one IR operation. It is useful for targets that support compressing store operations and allows vectorizing loops with cross-iteration dependences like in the following example:
14589 // In this loop we load elements from A and store them consecutively in B
14590 double *A, B; int *C;
14591 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14597 .. code-block:: llvm
14599 ; Load elements from A.
14600 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14601 ; Store all selected elements consecutively in array B
14602 call <void> @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14604 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14605 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14606 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14607 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14608 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14611 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14617 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
14618 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
14622 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
14623 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14630 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14635 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
14641 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14642 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14648 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
14649 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
14650 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
14651 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
14655 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
14656 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14663 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14668 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
14674 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14675 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14681 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
14682 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
14683 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
14684 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
14686 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
14687 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14691 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14695 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14700 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
14701 a memory object will not change.
14706 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14707 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14713 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
14714 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
14717 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
14718 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14722 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14726 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14731 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
14732 memory object are mutable.
14737 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
14738 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14739 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
14740 pointer to the object.
14745 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
14747 '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14748 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14752 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14753 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14758 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14763 The '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14764 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new
14765 pointer value that carries fresh invariant group information. It is an
14766 experimental intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the
14773 The ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14779 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
14780 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14781 It does not read any accessible memory and the execution can be speculated.
14783 '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14784 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14788 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14789 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14794 declare i8* @llvm.strip.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14799 The '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14800 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
14801 value that does not carry the invariant information. It is an experimental
14802 intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the future.
14808 The ``llvm.strip.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14814 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which has no associated
14815 ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14816 It does not read any memory and can be speculated.
14822 Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics
14823 -------------------------------------
14825 These intrinsics are used to provide special handling of floating-point
14826 operations when specific rounding mode or floating-point exception behavior is
14827 required. By default, LLVM optimization passes assume that the rounding mode is
14828 round-to-nearest and that floating-point exceptions will not be monitored.
14829 Constrained FP intrinsics are used to support non-default rounding modes and
14830 accurately preserve exception behavior without compromising LLVM's ability to
14831 optimize FP code when the default behavior is used.
14833 Each of these intrinsics corresponds to a normal floating-point operation. The
14834 first two arguments and the return value are the same as the corresponding FP
14837 The third argument is a metadata argument specifying the rounding mode to be
14838 assumed. This argument must be one of the following strings:
14848 If this argument is "round.dynamic" optimization passes must assume that the
14849 rounding mode is unknown and may change at runtime. No transformations that
14850 depend on rounding mode may be performed in this case.
14852 The other possible values for the rounding mode argument correspond to the
14853 similarly named IEEE rounding modes. If the argument is any of these values
14854 optimization passes may perform transformations as long as they are consistent
14855 with the specified rounding mode.
14857 For example, 'x-0'->'x' is not a valid transformation if the rounding mode is
14858 "round.downward" or "round.dynamic" because if the value of 'x' is +0 then
14859 'x-0' should evaluate to '-0' when rounding downward. However, this
14860 transformation is legal for all other rounding modes.
14862 For values other than "round.dynamic" optimization passes may assume that the
14863 actual runtime rounding mode (as defined in a target-specific manner) matches
14864 the specified rounding mode, but this is not guaranteed. Using a specific
14865 non-dynamic rounding mode which does not match the actual rounding mode at
14866 runtime results in undefined behavior.
14868 The fourth argument to the constrained floating-point intrinsics specifies the
14869 required exception behavior. This argument must be one of the following
14878 If this argument is "fpexcept.ignore" optimization passes may assume that the
14879 exception status flags will not be read and that floating-point exceptions will
14880 be masked. This allows transformations to be performed that may change the
14881 exception semantics of the original code. For example, FP operations may be
14882 speculatively executed in this case whereas they must not be for either of the
14883 other possible values of this argument.
14885 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.maytrap" optimization passes
14886 must avoid transformations that may raise exceptions that would not have been
14887 raised by the original code (such as speculatively executing FP operations), but
14888 passes are not required to preserve all exceptions that are implied by the
14889 original code. For example, exceptions may be potentially hidden by constant
14892 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.strict" all transformations must
14893 strictly preserve the floating-point exception semantics of the original code.
14894 Any FP exception that would have been raised by the original code must be raised
14895 by the transformed code, and the transformed code must not raise any FP
14896 exceptions that would not have been raised by the original code. This is the
14897 exception behavior argument that will be used if the code being compiled reads
14898 the FP exception status flags, but this mode can also be used with code that
14899 unmasks FP exceptions.
14901 The number and order of floating-point exceptions is NOT guaranteed. For
14902 example, a series of FP operations that each may raise exceptions may be
14903 vectorized into a single instruction that raises each unique exception a single
14907 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' Intrinsic
14908 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14916 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14917 metadata <rounding mode>,
14918 metadata <exception behavior>)
14923 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' intrinsic returns the sum of its
14930 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``'
14931 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14932 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14934 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14935 behavior as described above.
14940 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two value operands and has
14941 the same type as the operands.
14944 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' Intrinsic
14945 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14953 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14954 metadata <rounding mode>,
14955 metadata <exception behavior>)
14960 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' intrinsic returns the difference
14961 of its two operands.
14967 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``'
14968 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14969 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14971 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14972 behavior as described above.
14977 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two value operands
14978 and has the same type as the operands.
14981 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' Intrinsic
14982 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14990 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14991 metadata <rounding mode>,
14992 metadata <exception behavior>)
14997 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' intrinsic returns the product of
15004 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``'
15005 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15006 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15008 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15009 behavior as described above.
15014 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two value operands and
15015 has the same type as the operands.
15018 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' Intrinsic
15019 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15027 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15028 metadata <rounding mode>,
15029 metadata <exception behavior>)
15034 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' intrinsic returns the quotient of
15041 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``'
15042 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15043 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15045 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15046 behavior as described above.
15051 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two value operands and
15052 has the same type as the operands.
15055 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' Intrinsic
15056 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15064 @llvm.experimental.constrained.frem(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15065 metadata <rounding mode>,
15066 metadata <exception behavior>)
15071 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' intrinsic returns the remainder
15072 from the division of its two operands.
15078 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``'
15079 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
15080 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
15082 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15083 behavior as described above. The rounding mode argument has no effect, since
15084 the result of frem is never rounded, but the argument is included for
15085 consistency with the other constrained floating-point intrinsics.
15090 The value produced is the floating-point remainder from the division of the two
15091 value operands and has the same type as the operands. The remainder has the
15092 same sign as the dividend.
15094 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' Intrinsic
15095 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15103 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fma(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>, <type> <op3>,
15104 metadata <rounding mode>,
15105 metadata <exception behavior>)
15110 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' intrinsic returns the result of a
15111 fused-multiply-add operation on its operands.
15116 The first three arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``'
15117 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15118 <t_vector>` of floating-point values. All arguments must have identical types.
15120 The fourth and fifth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception behavior
15121 as described above.
15126 The result produced is the product of the first two operands added to the third
15127 operand computed with infinite precision, and then rounded to the target
15130 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``' Intrinsic
15131 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15139 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc(<type> <value>,
15140 metadata <rounding mode>,
15141 metadata <exception behavior>)
15146 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``' intrinsic truncates ``value``
15152 The first argument to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fptrunc``'
15153 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15154 <t_vector>` of floating point values. This argument must be larger in size
15157 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15158 behavior as described above.
15163 The result produced is a floating point value truncated to be smaller in size
15166 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``' Intrinsic
15167 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15175 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext(<type> <value>,
15176 metadata <exception behavior>)
15181 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``' intrinsic extends a
15182 floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point value.
15187 The first argument to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fpext``'
15188 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
15189 <t_vector>` of floating point values. This argument must be smaller in size
15192 The second argument specifies the exception behavior as described above.
15197 The result produced is a floating point value extended to be larger in size
15198 than the operand. All restrictions that apply to the fpext instruction also
15199 apply to this intrinsic.
15201 Constrained libm-equivalent Intrinsics
15202 --------------------------------------
15204 In addition to the basic floating-point operations for which constrained
15205 intrinsics are described above, there are constrained versions of various
15206 operations which provide equivalent behavior to a corresponding libm function.
15207 These intrinsics allow the precise behavior of these operations with respect to
15208 rounding mode and exception behavior to be controlled.
15210 As with the basic constrained floating-point intrinsics, the rounding mode
15211 and exception behavior arguments only control the behavior of the optimizer.
15212 They do not change the runtime floating-point environment.
15215 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' Intrinsic
15216 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15224 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt(<type> <op1>,
15225 metadata <rounding mode>,
15226 metadata <exception behavior>)
15231 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' intrinsic returns the square root
15232 of the specified value, returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``'
15233 functions would, but without setting ``errno``.
15238 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15241 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15242 behavior as described above.
15247 This function returns the nonnegative square root of the specified value.
15248 If the value is less than negative zero, a floating-point exception occurs
15249 and the return value is architecture specific.
15252 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' Intrinsic
15253 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15261 @llvm.experimental.constrained.pow(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
15262 metadata <rounding mode>,
15263 metadata <exception behavior>)
15268 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' intrinsic returns the first operand
15269 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand.
15274 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers of the
15275 same type. The second argument specifies the power to which the first argument
15278 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15279 behavior as described above.
15284 This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
15285 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
15286 handles error conditions in the same way.
15289 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' Intrinsic
15290 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15298 @llvm.experimental.constrained.powi(<type> <op1>, i32 <op2>,
15299 metadata <rounding mode>,
15300 metadata <exception behavior>)
15305 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' intrinsic returns the first operand
15306 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand. The
15307 order of evaluation of multiplications is not defined. When a vector of
15308 floating-point type is used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
15314 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15315 type. The second argument is a 32-bit signed integer specifying the power to
15316 which the first argument should be raised.
15318 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15319 behavior as described above.
15324 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
15325 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
15328 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' Intrinsic
15329 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15337 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sin(<type> <op1>,
15338 metadata <rounding mode>,
15339 metadata <exception behavior>)
15344 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' intrinsic returns the sine of the
15350 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15353 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15354 behavior as described above.
15359 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
15360 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
15361 conditions in the same way.
15364 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' Intrinsic
15365 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15373 @llvm.experimental.constrained.cos(<type> <op1>,
15374 metadata <rounding mode>,
15375 metadata <exception behavior>)
15380 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' intrinsic returns the cosine of the
15386 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
15389 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15390 behavior as described above.
15395 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
15396 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
15397 conditions in the same way.
15400 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' Intrinsic
15401 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15409 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp(<type> <op1>,
15410 metadata <rounding mode>,
15411 metadata <exception behavior>)
15416 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' intrinsic computes the base-e
15417 exponential of the specified value.
15422 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15425 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15426 behavior as described above.
15431 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
15432 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15435 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' Intrinsic
15436 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15444 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2(<type> <op1>,
15445 metadata <rounding mode>,
15446 metadata <exception behavior>)
15451 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
15452 exponential of the specified value.
15458 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15461 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15462 behavior as described above.
15467 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
15468 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15471 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' Intrinsic
15472 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15480 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log(<type> <op1>,
15481 metadata <rounding mode>,
15482 metadata <exception behavior>)
15487 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' intrinsic computes the base-e
15488 logarithm of the specified value.
15493 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15496 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15497 behavior as described above.
15503 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
15504 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15507 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' Intrinsic
15508 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15516 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log10(<type> <op1>,
15517 metadata <rounding mode>,
15518 metadata <exception behavior>)
15523 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' intrinsic computes the base-10
15524 logarithm of the specified value.
15529 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15532 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15533 behavior as described above.
15538 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
15539 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15542 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' Intrinsic
15543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15551 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log2(<type> <op1>,
15552 metadata <rounding mode>,
15553 metadata <exception behavior>)
15558 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
15559 logarithm of the specified value.
15564 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15567 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15568 behavior as described above.
15573 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
15574 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15577 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' Intrinsic
15578 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15586 @llvm.experimental.constrained.rint(<type> <op1>,
15587 metadata <rounding mode>,
15588 metadata <exception behavior>)
15593 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' intrinsic returns the first
15594 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point
15595 exception if the operand is not an integer.
15600 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15603 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15604 behavior as described above.
15609 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
15610 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15611 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15612 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15613 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15616 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' Intrinsic
15617 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15625 @llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint(<type> <op1>,
15626 metadata <rounding mode>,
15627 metadata <exception behavior>)
15632 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' intrinsic returns the first
15633 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It will not raise an inexact
15634 floating-point exception if the operand is not an integer.
15640 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15643 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15644 behavior as described above.
15649 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` functions
15650 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15651 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15652 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15653 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15656 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' Intrinsic
15657 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15665 @llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15666 metadata <rounding mode>,
15667 metadata <exception behavior>)
15672 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' intrinsic returns the maximum
15673 of the two arguments.
15678 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15681 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15682 behavior as described above.
15687 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum. The rounding mode is
15688 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15689 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15690 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15693 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' Intrinsic
15694 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15702 @llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15703 metadata <rounding mode>,
15704 metadata <exception behavior>)
15709 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' intrinsic returns the minimum
15710 of the two arguments.
15715 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15718 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15719 behavior as described above.
15724 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum. The rounding mode is
15725 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15726 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15727 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15730 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' Intrinsic
15731 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15739 @llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil(<type> <op1>,
15740 metadata <rounding mode>,
15741 metadata <exception behavior>)
15746 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' intrinsic returns the ceiling of the
15752 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15755 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15756 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15762 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
15763 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15766 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' Intrinsic
15767 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15775 @llvm.experimental.constrained.floor(<type> <op1>,
15776 metadata <rounding mode>,
15777 metadata <exception behavior>)
15782 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' intrinsic returns the floor of the
15788 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15791 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15792 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15798 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
15799 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15802 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' Intrinsic
15803 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15811 @llvm.experimental.constrained.round(<type> <op1>,
15812 metadata <rounding mode>,
15813 metadata <exception behavior>)
15818 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' intrinsic returns the first
15819 operand rounded to the nearest integer.
15824 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15827 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15828 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15834 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round`` functions
15835 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15838 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' Intrinsic
15839 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15847 @llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc(<type> <op1>,
15848 metadata <truncing mode>,
15849 metadata <exception behavior>)
15854 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' intrinsic returns the first
15855 operand rounded to the nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the
15861 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15864 The second and third arguments specify the truncing mode and exception
15865 behavior as described above. The truncing mode is currently unused for this
15871 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
15872 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15878 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
15881 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
15882 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15889 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15894 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
15899 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
15900 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
15901 source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
15906 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
15907 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
15908 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
15909 ignored by code generation and optimization.
15911 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
15912 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15917 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
15918 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
15919 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
15924 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15925 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15926 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15927 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15928 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15933 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
15938 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
15939 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
15940 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
15941 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
15946 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
15947 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
15948 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
15949 generation and optimization.
15951 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
15952 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15957 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
15958 any integer bit width.
15962 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15963 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15964 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15965 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15966 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15971 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
15976 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
15977 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
15978 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
15979 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
15984 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
15985 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
15986 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
15987 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
15989 '``llvm.codeview.annotation``' Intrinsic
15990 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15995 This annotation emits a label at its program point and an associated
15996 ``S_ANNOTATION`` codeview record with some additional string metadata. This is
15997 used to implement MSVC's ``__annotation`` intrinsic. It is marked
15998 ``noduplicate``, so calls to this intrinsic prevent inlining and should be
15999 considered expensive.
16003 declare void @llvm.codeview.annotation(metadata)
16008 The argument should be an MDTuple containing any number of MDStrings.
16010 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
16011 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16018 declare void @llvm.trap() cold noreturn nounwind
16023 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
16033 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
16034 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
16035 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
16037 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
16038 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16045 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
16050 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
16060 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
16061 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
16064 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
16065 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16072 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
16077 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
16078 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
16079 is placed on the stack before local variables.
16084 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
16085 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
16086 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
16087 enough space to hold the value of the guard.
16092 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
16093 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
16094 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
16095 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
16096 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
16097 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
16098 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
16100 '``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
16101 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16108 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
16113 The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
16115 It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
16116 The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
16117 Protector in FastISel.
16127 On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
16128 between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
16129 global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
16131 Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
16132 X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
16135 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
16136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16143 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
16144 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
16149 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to the
16150 optimizer to determine whether a) an operation (like memcpy) will overflow a
16151 buffer that corresponds to an object, or b) that a runtime check for overflow
16152 isn't necessary. An object in this context means an allocation of a specific
16153 class, structure, array, or other object.
16158 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes four arguments. The first argument is a
16159 pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument determines whether
16160 ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) or -1 (if false) when the object size is
16161 unknown. The third argument controls how ``llvm.objectsize`` acts when ``null``
16162 in address space 0 is used as its pointer argument. If it's ``false``,
16163 ``llvm.objectsize`` reports 0 bytes available when given ``null``. Otherwise, if
16164 the ``null`` is in a non-zero address space or if ``true`` is given for the
16165 third argument of ``llvm.objectsize``, we assume its size is unknown. The fourth
16166 argument to ``llvm.objectsize`` determines if the value should be evaluated at
16169 The second, third, and fourth arguments only accept constants.
16174 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a value representing the size of
16175 the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined, ``llvm.objectsize``
16176 returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending on the ``min`` argument).
16178 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
16179 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16184 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
16189 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
16190 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
16191 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
16196 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
16197 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
16202 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
16203 a value. The second argument is an expected value.
16208 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
16212 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
16213 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16220 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
16225 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
16226 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
16232 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
16237 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
16238 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
16239 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
16240 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
16241 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
16243 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
16244 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
16245 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
16246 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
16247 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
16248 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
16249 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
16254 '``llvm.ssa_copy``' Intrinsic
16255 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16262 declare type @llvm.ssa_copy(type %operand) returned(1) readnone
16267 The first argument is an operand which is used as the returned value.
16272 The ``llvm.ssa_copy`` intrinsic can be used to attach information to
16273 operations by copying them and giving them new names. For example,
16274 the PredicateInfo utility uses it to build Extended SSA form, and
16275 attach various forms of information to operands that dominate specific
16276 uses. It is not meant for general use, only for building temporary
16277 renaming forms that require value splits at certain points.
16281 '``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
16282 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16289 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
16295 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
16296 metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
16301 The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
16302 with the given type identifier.
16304 '``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
16305 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16312 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
16318 The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
16319 second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
16320 third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
16326 The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
16327 virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
16328 control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
16329 virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
16330 intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
16331 check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
16334 If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
16335 function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
16336 the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
16337 with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
16338 element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
16340 - If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
16341 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
16344 - If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
16345 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
16347 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
16348 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
16351 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
16352 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
16354 If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
16355 first element is undefined.
16358 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
16359 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16366 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
16371 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
16372 three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
16373 ``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
16384 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
16387 '``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
16388 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16395 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
16400 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
16401 <deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
16402 frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
16403 hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
16406 In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
16407 this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
16408 functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
16409 used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
16415 The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
16416 decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
16421 The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
16422 deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
16423 operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
16424 the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
16425 the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
16426 as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
16427 invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
16430 Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
16431 continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
16432 calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
16434 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
16435 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
16436 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
16437 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
16439 Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
16440 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
16443 The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
16444 ``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
16445 intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
16447 All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
16448 same calling convention.
16450 .. _deoptimize_lowering:
16455 Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
16456 symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
16457 ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
16458 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
16459 arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
16462 '``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
16463 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16470 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
16475 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
16476 <deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
16477 optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
16478 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
16479 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
16482 .. code-block:: text
16484 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
16485 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
16486 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
16489 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
16497 with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
16498 is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
16499 see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
16501 In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
16502 ``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
16503 is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
16504 with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
16505 i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
16506 if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
16508 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
16511 '``llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``' Intrinsic
16512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16519 declare i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16524 This intrinsic represents a "widenable condition" which is
16525 boolean expressions with the following property: whether this
16526 expression is `true` or `false`, the program is correct and
16529 Together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles <deopt_opbundles>`,
16530 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` allows frontends to
16531 express guards or checks on optimistic assumptions made during
16532 compilation and represent them as branch instructions on special
16535 While this may appear similar in semantics to `undef`, it is very
16536 different in that an invocation produces a particular, singular
16537 value. It is also intended to be lowered late, and remain available
16538 for specific optimizations and transforms that can benefit from its
16539 special properties.
16549 The intrinsic ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()``
16550 returns either `true` or `false`. For each evaluation of a call
16551 to this intrinsic, the program must be valid and correct both if
16552 it returns `true` and if it returns `false`. This allows
16553 transformation passes to replace evaluations of this intrinsic
16554 with either value whenever one is beneficial.
16556 When used in a branch condition, it allows us to choose between
16557 two alternative correct solutions for the same problem, like
16560 .. code-block:: text
16562 %cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16563 br i1 %cond, label %solution_1, label %solution_2
16566 ; Apply memory-consuming but fast solution for a task.
16569 ; Cheap in memory but slow solution.
16571 Whether the result of intrinsic's call is `true` or `false`,
16572 it should be correct to pick either solution. We can switch
16573 between them by replacing the result of
16574 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with different
16577 This is how it can be used to represent guards as widenable branches:
16579 .. code-block:: text
16582 ; Unguarded instructions
16583 call void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %cond, <args...>) ["deopt"(<deopt_args...>)]
16584 ; Guarded instructions
16586 Can be expressed in an alternative equivalent form of explicit branch using
16587 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``:
16589 .. code-block:: text
16592 ; Unguarded instructions
16593 %widenable_condition = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16594 %guard_condition = and i1 %cond, %widenable_condition
16595 br i1 %guard_condition, label %guarded, label %deopt
16598 ; Guarded instructions
16601 call type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"(<deopt_args...>) ]
16603 So the block `guarded` is only reachable when `%cond` is `true`,
16604 and it should be valid to go to the block `deopt` whenever `%cond`
16605 is `true` or `false`.
16607 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` will never throw, thus
16608 it cannot be invoked.
16613 When ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()`` is used in
16614 condition of a guard represented as explicit branch, it is
16615 legal to widen the guard's condition with any additional
16618 Guard widening looks like replacement of
16620 .. code-block:: text
16622 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16623 %guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %widenable_cond
16624 br i1 %guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16628 .. code-block:: text
16630 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16631 %new_cond = and i1 %any_other_cond, %widenable_cond
16632 %new_guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %new_cond
16633 br i1 %new_guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16635 for this branch. Here `%any_other_cond` is an arbitrarily chosen
16636 well-defined `i1` value. By making guard widening, we may
16637 impose stricter conditions on `guarded` block and bail to the
16638 deopt when the new condition is not met.
16643 Default lowering strategy is replacing the result of
16644 call of ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with
16645 constant `true`. However it is always correct to replace
16646 it with any other `i1` value. Any pass can
16647 freely do it if it can benefit from non-default lowering.
16650 '``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
16651 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16658 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
16663 This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
16664 adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
16665 recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
16666 load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
16667 ``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
16669 LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
16670 not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
16671 ``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
16672 a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
16673 used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
16675 '``llvm.sideeffect``' Intrinsic
16676 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16683 declare void @llvm.sideeffect() inaccessiblememonly nounwind
16688 The ``llvm.sideeffect`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. Optimizers
16689 treat it as having side effects, so it can be inserted into a loop to
16690 indicate that the loop shouldn't be assumed to terminate (which could
16691 potentially lead to the loop being optimized away entirely), even if it's
16692 an infinite loop with no other side effects.
16702 This intrinsic actually does nothing, but optimizers must assume that it
16703 has externally observable side effects.
16705 '``llvm.is.constant.*``' Intrinsic
16706 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16711 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.is.constant with any argument type.
16715 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %operand) nounwind readnone
16716 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.f32(float %operand) nounwind readnone
16717 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.TYPENAME(TYPE %operand) nounwind readnone
16722 The '``llvm.is.constant``' intrinsic will return true if the argument
16723 is known to be a manifest compile-time constant. It is guaranteed to
16724 fold to either true or false before generating machine code.
16729 This intrinsic generates no code. If its argument is known to be a
16730 manifest compile-time constant value, then the intrinsic will be
16731 converted to a constant true value. Otherwise, it will be converted to
16732 a constant false value.
16734 In particular, note that if the argument is a constant expression
16735 which refers to a global (the address of which _is_ a constant, but
16736 not manifest during the compile), then the intrinsic evaluates to
16739 The result also intentionally depends on the result of optimization
16740 passes -- e.g., the result can change depending on whether a
16741 function gets inlined or not. A function's parameters are
16742 obviously not constant. However, a call like
16743 ``llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %param)`` *can* return true after the
16744 function is inlined, if the value passed to the function parameter was
16747 On the other hand, if constant folding is not run, it will never
16748 evaluate to true, even in simple cases.
16750 Stack Map Intrinsics
16751 --------------------
16753 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
16754 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
16755 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
16757 Element Wise Atomic Memory Intrinsics
16758 -------------------------------------
16760 These intrinsics are similar to the standard library memory intrinsics except
16761 that they perform memory transfer as a sequence of atomic memory accesses.
16763 .. _int_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic:
16765 '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16766 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16771 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic`` on
16772 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
16773 support all bit widths however.
16777 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16780 i32 <element_size>)
16781 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16784 i32 <element_size>)
16789 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
16790 '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and ``src`` are treated
16791 as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the copy between
16792 buffers uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations
16793 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16798 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`
16799 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
16800 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
16801 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16803 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
16804 target-specific atomic access size limit.
16806 For each of the input pointers ``align`` parameter attribute must be specified. It
16807 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
16808 both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
16813 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes of
16814 memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations are not
16815 allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store operations
16816 where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and
16817 aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16819 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16820 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16821 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source and
16822 destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when specified.
16824 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16825 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
16831 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
16832 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
16833 is replaced with an actual element size.
16835 Optimizer is allowed to inline memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
16837 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16838 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16843 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use
16844 ``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic`` on any integer bit width and for
16845 different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
16849 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16852 i32 <element_size>)
16853 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16856 i32 <element_size>)
16861 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization
16862 of the '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and
16863 ``src`` are treated as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size``
16864 bytes, and the copy between buffers uses a sequence of
16865 :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations that are a positive
16866 integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16871 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the
16872 :ref:`@llvm.memmove <int_memmove>` intrinsic, with the added constraint that
16873 ``len`` is required to be a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size``.
16874 If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of ``element_size``, then the
16875 behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16877 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no
16878 greater than a target-specific atomic access size limit.
16880 For each of the input pointers the ``align`` parameter attribute must be
16881 specified. It must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller
16882 guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that
16888 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes
16889 of memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations
16890 are allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store
16891 operations where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size``
16892 bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16894 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16895 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16896 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source
16897 and destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when
16900 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16901 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
16907 In the most general case call to the
16908 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is lowered to a call to the symbol
16909 ``__llvm_memmove_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*' is replaced with an
16910 actual element size.
16912 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
16914 .. _int_memset_element_unordered_atomic:
16916 '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16917 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16922 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic`` on
16923 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
16924 support all bit widths however.
16928 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16931 i32 <element_size>)
16932 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16935 i32 <element_size>)
16940 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
16941 '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` is treated as an array
16942 with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the assignment to that array
16943 uses uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` store operations
16944 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16949 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memset <int_memset>`
16950 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
16951 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
16952 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16954 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
16955 target-specific atomic access size limit.
16957 The ``dest`` input pointer must have the ``align`` parameter attribute specified. It
16958 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
16959 the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
16964 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic sets the ``len`` bytes of
16965 memory starting at the destination location to the given ``value``. The memory is
16966 set with a sequence of store operations where each access is guaranteed to be a
16967 multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16969 The order of the assignment is unspecified. Only one write is issued to the
16970 destination buffer per element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and
16971 writes to the destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic
16974 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16975 provided by a set of unordered stores to the destination.
16980 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
16981 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memset_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
16982 is replaced with an actual element size.
16984 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory assignment when it's profitable to do so.
16986 Objective-C ARC Runtime Intrinsics
16987 ----------------------------------
16989 LLVM provides intrinsics that lower to Objective-C ARC runtime entry points.
16990 LLVM is aware of the semantics of these functions, and optimizes based on that
16991 knowledge. You can read more about the details of Objective-C ARC `here
16992 <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html>`_.
16994 '``llvm.objc.autorelease``' Intrinsic
16995 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17001 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autorelease(i8*)
17006 Lowers to a call to `objc_autorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autorelease>`_.
17008 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop``' Intrinsic
17009 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17015 declare void @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop(i8*)
17020 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPop <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpop-void-pool>`_.
17022 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush``' Intrinsic
17023 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17029 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush()
17034 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPush <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpush-void>`_.
17036 '``llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17037 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17043 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
17048 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
17050 '``llvm.objc.copyWeak``' Intrinsic
17051 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17057 declare void @llvm.objc.copyWeak(i8**, i8**)
17062 Lowers to a call to `objc_copyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-copyweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
17064 '``llvm.objc.destroyWeak``' Intrinsic
17065 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17071 declare void @llvm.objc.destroyWeak(i8**)
17076 Lowers to a call to `objc_destroyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-destroyweak-id-object>`_.
17078 '``llvm.objc.initWeak``' Intrinsic
17079 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17085 declare i8* @llvm.objc.initWeak(i8**, i8*)
17090 Lowers to a call to `objc_initWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-initweak>`_.
17092 '``llvm.objc.loadWeak``' Intrinsic
17093 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17099 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeak(i8**)
17104 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweak>`_.
17106 '``llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained``' Intrinsic
17107 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17113 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained(i8**)
17118 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeakRetained <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweakretained>`_.
17120 '``llvm.objc.moveWeak``' Intrinsic
17121 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17127 declare void @llvm.objc.moveWeak(i8**, i8**)
17132 Lowers to a call to `objc_moveWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-moveweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
17134 '``llvm.objc.release``' Intrinsic
17135 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17141 declare void @llvm.objc.release(i8*)
17146 Lowers to a call to `objc_release <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-release-id-value>`_.
17148 '``llvm.objc.retain``' Intrinsic
17149 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17155 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retain(i8*)
17160 Lowers to a call to `objc_retain <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retain>`_.
17162 '``llvm.objc.retainAutorelease``' Intrinsic
17163 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17169 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutorelease(i8*)
17174 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautorelease>`_.
17176 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17177 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17183 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
17188 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
17190 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue``' Intrinsic
17191 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17197 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue(i8*)
17202 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleasedReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasedreturnvalue>`_.
17204 '``llvm.objc.retainBlock``' Intrinsic
17205 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17211 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainBlock(i8*)
17216 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainBlock <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainblock>`_.
17218 '``llvm.objc.storeStrong``' Intrinsic
17219 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17225 declare void @llvm.objc.storeStrong(i8**, i8*)
17230 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeStrong <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-storestrong-id-object-id-value>`_.
17232 '``llvm.objc.storeWeak``' Intrinsic
17233 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
17239 declare i8* @llvm.objc.storeWeak(i8**, i8*)
17244 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-storeweak>`_.